blob: d0417c047264c31eacda533fa18cc2c14e42e478 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
781 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
782 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
783 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
784 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
785 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200786
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200787tune.bufsize <number>
788 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
789 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
790 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
791 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
792 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
793 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
794 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
795 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400796 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
797 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
798 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200799
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200800tune.chksize <number>
801 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
802 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
803 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
804 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
805 checks whenever possible.
806
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100807tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
808 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
809 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
810 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
811 this value. The default value is 1.
812
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100813tune.http.cookielen <number>
814 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
815 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
816 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
817 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
818 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
819 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
820 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
821 to change this value.
822
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200823tune.http.maxhdr <number>
824 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
825 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
826 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
827 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
828 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
829 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
830 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
831 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
832 limit too high.
833
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100834tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100835 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
836 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
837 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
838 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
839 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
840 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
841 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
842 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
843 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
844 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100845
846tune.maxpollevents <number>
847 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
848 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
849 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
850 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
851 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
852
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200853tune.maxrewrite <number>
854 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
855 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
856 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
857 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
858 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
859 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
860 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
861 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
862 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
863 bufsize.
864
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200865tune.pipesize <number>
866 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
867 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
868 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
869 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
870 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
871 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
872
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100873tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
874tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
875 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
876 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
877 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
878 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
879 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
880 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
881 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
882
883tune.sndbuf.client <number>
884tune.sndbuf.server <number>
885 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
886 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
887 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
888 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
889 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
890 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
891 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
892 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
893 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
894 notifying haproxy again.
895
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100896tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100897 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
898 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
899 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
900 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
901 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
902 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
903 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
904 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
905 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100906 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
907 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100908
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100909tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
910 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
911 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
912 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
913 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
914 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
915 being used for too long.
916
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100917tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
918 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
919 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
920 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
921 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
922 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
923 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
924 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
925 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
926 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
927 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
928 best value.
929
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100930tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
931 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
932 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
933 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
934 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
935 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
936
937tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
938 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
939 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
940 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
941 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433.3. Debugging
944--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946debug
947 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
948 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
949 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
950 system startup.
951
952quiet
953 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
954 line argument "-q".
955
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009573.4. Userlists
958--------------
959It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
960http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
961it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
962
963userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100964 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100965 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
966
967group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100968 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100969 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
970 proceeded by "users" keyword.
971
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100972user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
973 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100974 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
975 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100976 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
977 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100978 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
979 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
980
981
982 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983 userlist L1
984 group G1 users tiger,scott
985 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100987 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
988 user scott insecure-password elgato
989 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100990
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100991 userlist L2
992 group G1
993 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100994
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100995 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
996 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
997 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100998
999 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001001
10023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001003----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001004It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1005haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1006pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1007identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1008or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1009Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1010known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1011the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1012process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1013during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1014tables.
1015
1016peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001017 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001018 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1019
1020peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1021 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1022 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1023 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1024 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1025 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1026 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1027
1028 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1029 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1030
1031 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1032 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1033 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1034 across all peers.
1035
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001036 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1037 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1038 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1039
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001040 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001041 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001042 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1043 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1044 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001045
1046 backend mybackend
1047 mode tcp
1048 balance roundrobin
1049 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1050 stick on src
1051
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001052 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1053 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001054
1055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010564. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001058
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1060 - defaults <name>
1061 - frontend <name>
1062 - backend <name>
1063 - listen <name>
1064
1065A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1066its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1067section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001068section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069
1070A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1071connections.
1072
1073A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1074to forward incoming connections.
1075
1076A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1077parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1080'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1081case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1082
1083Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1084logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1085proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1086However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1087name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1088
1089Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1090and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001091bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1093modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1094arbitrary criteria.
1095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010974.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1098--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001100The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1101limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1102they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1103limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001104marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001106and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1107with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1108specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001111 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1112------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1113acl - X X X
1114appsession - - X X
1115backlog X X X -
1116balance X - X X
1117bind - X X -
1118bind-process X X X X
1119block - X X X
1120capture cookie - X X -
1121capture request header - X X -
1122capture response header - X X -
1123clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001124compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001125contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1126cookie X - X X
1127default-server X - X X
1128default_backend X X X -
1129description - X X X
1130disabled X X X X
1131dispatch - - X X
1132enabled X X X X
1133errorfile X X X X
1134errorloc X X X X
1135errorloc302 X X X X
1136-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1137errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001138force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139fullconn X - X X
1140grace X X X X
1141hash-type X - X X
1142http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001143http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001144http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001145http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001146http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001147tcp-check expect - - X X
1148tcp-check send - - X X
1149tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001150http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001152ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001153log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001154maxconn X X X -
1155mode X X X X
1156monitor fail - X X -
1157monitor-net X X X -
1158monitor-uri X X X -
1159option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1160option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1161option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1162option allbackups (*) X - X X
1163option checkcache (*) X - X X
1164option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1165option contstats (*) X X X -
1166option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1167option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1168option forceclose (*) X X X X
1169-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1170option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001171option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001172option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001173option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001174option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1175option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1176option httpchk X - X X
1177option httpclose (*) X X X X
1178option httplog X X X X
1179option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001180option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001181option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001182option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1183option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1184option logasap (*) X X X -
1185option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001186option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187option nolinger (*) X X X X
1188option originalto X X X X
1189option persist (*) X - X X
1190option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001191option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001192option smtpchk X - X X
1193option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1194option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1195option splice-request (*) X X X X
1196option splice-response (*) X X X X
1197option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1198option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001200option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001201option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1202option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1203option tcpka X X X X
1204option tcplog X X X X
1205option transparent (*) X - X X
1206persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1207rate-limit sessions X X X -
1208redirect - X X X
1209redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1210redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1211reqadd - X X X
1212reqallow - X X X
1213reqdel - X X X
1214reqdeny - X X X
1215reqiallow - X X X
1216reqidel - X X X
1217reqideny - X X X
1218reqipass - X X X
1219reqirep - X X X
1220reqisetbe - X X X
1221reqitarpit - X X X
1222reqpass - X X X
1223reqrep - X X X
1224-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1225reqsetbe - X X X
1226reqtarpit - X X X
1227retries X - X X
1228rspadd - X X X
1229rspdel - X X X
1230rspdeny - X X X
1231rspidel - X X X
1232rspideny - X X X
1233rspirep - X X X
1234rsprep - X X X
1235server - - X X
1236source X - X X
1237srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001238stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001239stats auth X - X X
1240stats enable X - X X
1241stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001242stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001243stats realm X - X X
1244stats refresh X - X X
1245stats scope X - X X
1246stats show-desc X - X X
1247stats show-legends X - X X
1248stats show-node X - X X
1249stats uri X - X X
1250-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1251stick match - - X X
1252stick on - - X X
1253stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001254stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001255stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001256tcp-request connection - X X -
1257tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001258tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001259tcp-response content - - X X
1260tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001261timeout check X - X X
1262timeout client X X X -
1263timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1264timeout connect X - X X
1265timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1266timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1267timeout http-request X X X X
1268timeout queue X - X X
1269timeout server X - X X
1270timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1271timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001272timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001274unique-id-format X X X -
1275unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001276use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001277use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1279 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012824.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1283---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
1285This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1286
1287
1288acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1289 Declare or complete an access list.
1290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1291 no | yes | yes | yes
1292 Example:
1293 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1294 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1295 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001297 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001298
1299
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001300appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1301 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1304 no | no | yes | yes
1305 Arguments :
1306 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1307 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1308
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001309 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310 checked in each cookie value.
1311
1312 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1313 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1314 milliseconds.
1315
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001316 request-learn
1317 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1318 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1319 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1320 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1321 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1322 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1323
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001324 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1325 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1326 data following this prefix.
1327
1328 Example :
1329 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1330
1331 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1332 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1333
1334 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1335 2 modes are currently supported :
1336 - path-parameters :
1337 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1338 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1339 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1340 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1341 - query-string :
1342 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1343 query string.
1344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001345 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1346 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1347 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1348 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001349 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1350 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1351 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001352 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1353 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1354
1355 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1356
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001357 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1358 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1359 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361 Example :
1362 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1363
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001364 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1365 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001366
1367
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001368backlog <conns>
1369 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1371 yes | yes | yes | no
1372 Arguments :
1373 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1374 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001375 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001376
1377 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1378 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1379 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1380 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1381 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1382 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1383 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1384 backlog parameter.
1385
1386 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1387 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1388 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1389
1390 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1391
1392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001393balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001394balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001395 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1397 yes | no | yes | yes
1398 Arguments :
1399 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1400 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1401 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1402 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1403
1404 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1405 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1406 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1407 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001408 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001409 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001410 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1411 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1412 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1413 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1414 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1415 it, so that you don't worry.
1416
1417 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1418 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1419 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1420 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1421 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1422 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1423 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1424 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001425
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001426 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1427 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1428 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1429 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1430 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1431 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1432 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1433 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1434
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001435 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1436 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1437 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1438 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001439 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001440 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1441 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1442 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1443 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1444 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001445 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1446 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1447 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1448 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1449 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1450 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1453 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1454 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1455 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1456 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1457 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1458 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1459 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001460 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001461 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001462 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1463 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1464 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001466 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1467 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1468 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1469 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1470 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1471 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1472 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1473 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1474 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1475 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1476 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1477 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001479 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001480 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1481 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1482 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1483 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1484 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1485 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1486 URIs start with a leading "/".
1487
1488 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1489 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1490 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1491 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001493 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001494 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1495
1496 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1498 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1499 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1500 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1501 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1502 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1503 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1504 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1505 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1506 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1507 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1508 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1509 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1510 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1511 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1512 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1513 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1514 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1515 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001516
1517 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1518 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1519 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1520 server will receive the request.
1521
1522 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1523 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1524 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1525 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1526 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001527 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1528 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1529 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001531 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1532 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1533 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1534 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1535 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001537 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001538 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1539 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1540 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1541
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001542 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1543 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1544 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1545
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001546 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001547 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001548 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1549 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1550 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1551 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1552 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1553 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001554 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001555 used instead.
1556
1557 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1558 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1559 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1560 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1561
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001562 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1563 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1564 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1565
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001566 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001569 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1570 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001571
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001572 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001573 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001575 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1576 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1577 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578
1579 Examples :
1580 balance roundrobin
1581 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001582 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001583 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1584 balance hdr(host)
1585 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001586
1587 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1588 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001590 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001591 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1592 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1593 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1594 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1595
1596 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1597 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1598 defaults to 16 kB.
1599
1600 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1601 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1602
1603 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1604 Round Robin.
1605
1606 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1607 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1608 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1609 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1610
1611 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1612
1613 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001614 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001615 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1616 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1617 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001619 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1620 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621
1622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001623bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1624bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1627 no | yes | yes | no
1628 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001629 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1630 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1631 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1632 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001633 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001634 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1635 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1636 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1637 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1638 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1639 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1640 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001641 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1642 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1643 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001644 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1645 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1646 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1647 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001648
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001649 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1650 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001651 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1652 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1653 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001654 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1655 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1656 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1657 the range.
1658
1659 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1660 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1661 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1662 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1663 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1664 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1665 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001666 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001667 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001669 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1670 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1671 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1672 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1673 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1674 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1675 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1676 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001678 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1679 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1680 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1681 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1684 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1685 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1686 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1687 in a frontend.
1688
1689 Example :
1690 listen http_proxy
1691 bind :80,:443
1692 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001693 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001695 listen http_https_proxy
1696 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001697 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001698
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001699 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1700 bind ipv6@:80
1701 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1702 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1703
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001704 listen external_bind_app1
1705 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1706
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001707 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001708 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
1710
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001711bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001712 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1714 yes | yes | yes | yes
1715 Arguments :
1716 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1717 may be used to override a default value.
1718
1719 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1720 option may be combined with other numbers.
1721
1722 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1723 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1724 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1725 missing from all processes.
1726
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001727 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1728 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1729 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1730 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1731 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001732
1733 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1734 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1735 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1736 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1737 and 'even' instances.
1738
1739 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1740 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1741 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1742 32.
1743
1744 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1745 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1746
1747 Example :
1748 listen app_ip1
1749 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001750 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001751
1752 listen app_ip2
1753 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001754 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001755
1756 listen management
1757 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001758 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001759
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001760 listen management
1761 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1762 bind-process 1-4
1763
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001764 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1765
1766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767block { if | unless } <condition>
1768 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1770 no | yes | yes | yes
1771
1772 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1773 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001774 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001775 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1777 "block" statements per instance.
1778
1779 Example:
1780 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1781 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1782 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1783 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
1787
1788capture cookie <name> len <length>
1789 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1791 no | yes | yes | no
1792 Arguments :
1793 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1794 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1795 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1796 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1797 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1798
1799 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1800 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1801 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1802 right if it exceeds <length>.
1803
1804 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1805 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1806 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1807 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1808
1809 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1810 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1811 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1812
1813 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1814 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1815 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001816 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1817 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1818 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819
1820 Example:
1821 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1822
1823 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001824 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825
1826
1827capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001828 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1830 no | yes | yes | no
1831 Arguments :
1832 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001833 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1835 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1836 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1837
1838 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1839 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1840 it exceeds <length>.
1841
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001842 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1844 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001845 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1846 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1847 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1848 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001849 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001850 environments to find where the request came from.
1851
1852 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1853 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1854 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1855 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001857 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1858 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1859 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1860 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1861 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862
1863 Example:
1864 capture request header Host len 15
1865 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1866 capture request header Referrer len 15
1867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001868 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 about logging.
1870
1871
1872capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001873 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1875 no | yes | yes | no
1876 Arguments :
1877 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001878 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1880 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1881 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1882
1883 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1884 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1885 it exceeds <length>.
1886
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001887 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001888 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1889 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1890 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001891 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1892 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1893 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1894 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001896 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1897 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1898 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1899 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1900 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
1902 Example:
1903 capture response header Content-length len 9
1904 capture response header Location len 15
1905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001906 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 about logging.
1908
1909
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001910clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1913 yes | yes | yes | no
1914 Arguments :
1915 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1917 as explained at the top of this document.
1918
1919 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1920 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1921 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1922 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1923 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1924 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1925 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1926 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001927 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1929 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1930
1931 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1932 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1933 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1934 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1935 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1936 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1937
1938 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1939 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1940
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001941 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1942 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001944compression algo <algorithm> ...
1945compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001946compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001947 Enable HTTP compression.
1948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1949 yes | yes | yes | yes
1950 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001951 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1952 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1953 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1954
1955 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001956 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001957 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1958 data.
1959
1960 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1961 support for zlib was built in.
1962
1963 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1964 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1965 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1966 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1967 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1968 in.
1969
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001970 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001971 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001972 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1973 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1974 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1975 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1976 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001977
1978 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1979 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1980 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1981 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1982 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001983 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1984 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1985 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1986 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1987 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1988 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001989
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001990 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001991 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1992 "Accept-Encoding" header
1993 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001994 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01001995 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
1996 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001997 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1998 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1999 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2000 "multipart"
2001 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2002 header
2003 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2004 and later
2005 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2006 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002007
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002008 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2009 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002010
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002011 Examples :
2012 compression algo gzip
2013 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002015contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2018 yes | no | yes | yes
2019 Arguments :
2020 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2022 as explained at the top of this document.
2023
2024 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002025 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002026 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2028 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2029 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2030 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2031
2032 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2033 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2034 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2035 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2036 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2037 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2038
2039 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2040 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2041 instead.
2042
2043 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2044 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2045
2046
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002047cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002048 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2049 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2052 yes | no | yes | yes
2053 Arguments :
2054 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2055 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2056 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2057 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2058 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2059 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2060 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2061 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2062 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2063
2064 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2065 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2066 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2067 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2068 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2069 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2070 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2071 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2072 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2073 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2074 "insert" and "prefix".
2075
2076 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002077 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002078
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002079 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002080 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2081 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2082 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2083 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2084 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2085 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2086 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2087 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2088 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2089 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090
2091 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2092 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2093 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2094 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2095 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2096 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2097 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2098 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2099 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2100 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002101 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2102 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2103 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002105 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2106 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2107 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002108 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2109 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2110 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2111 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002112 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2113 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2114 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115
2116 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2117 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2118 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2119 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2120 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2121 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2122 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2123 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2124 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2125
2126 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2127 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2128 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2129 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2130 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2131 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2132 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2133 persistence cookie in the cache.
2134 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2135
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002136 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2137 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2138 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2139 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2140 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2141 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2142 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2143 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2144 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2145 they logout.
2146
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002147 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2148 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2149 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2150 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2151
2152 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2153 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2154 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2155 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2156 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2157 this attribute.
2158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002159 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002160 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002161 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2162 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2163 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2164 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2165 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2166 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002167
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002168 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2169 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2170 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2171 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2172 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2173 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2174 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2175 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2176 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2177 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2178 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2179 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2180 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2181 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2182 the site.
2183
2184 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2185 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2186 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2187 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2188 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2189 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2190 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2191 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2192 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2193 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2194 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2195 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2196 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2197 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2198 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2199 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002201 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2202 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2203 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2204 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206 Examples :
2207 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2208 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2209 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002210 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002212 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002213 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002216default-server [param*]
2217 Change default options for a server in a backend
2218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2219 yes | no | yes | yes
2220 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002221 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2222 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2223 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2224 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002225
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002226 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002227 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2228
2229 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232default_backend <backend>
2233 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | yes | yes | no
2236 Arguments :
2237 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2238
2239 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2240 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2241 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2242 will catch all undetermined requests.
2243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244 Example :
2245
2246 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2247 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2248 default_backend dynamic
2249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002250 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002253description <string>
2254 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2256 no | yes | yes | yes
2257 Arguments : string
2258
2259 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2260 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2261 it describes.
2262 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2263
2264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265disabled
2266 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2268 yes | yes | yes | yes
2269 Arguments : none
2270
2271 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2272 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2273 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2274 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2275 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2276 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2277 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2278
2279 See also : "enabled"
2280
2281
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002282dispatch <address>:<port>
2283 Set a default server address
2284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2285 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002286 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002287
2288 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2289 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2290 during start-up.
2291
2292 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2293 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2294 possible with normal servers.
2295
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002296 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002297 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2298 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2299 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2300 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2301
2302 See also : "server"
2303
2304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305enabled
2306 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 yes | yes | yes | yes
2309 Arguments : none
2310
2311 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2312 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2313
2314 See also : "disabled"
2315
2316
2317errorfile <code> <file>
2318 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2320 yes | yes | yes | yes
2321 Arguments :
2322 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002323 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324
2325 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002326 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002328 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2329 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330
2331 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2332 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2333 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2334
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002335 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2338 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2339 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2340 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2341
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002342 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2343 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2344 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2345 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2346 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2347 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2350 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2351 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002352 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2354
2355 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2356
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002357 Example :
2358 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2359 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2360 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2361
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002362
2363errorloc <code> <url>
2364errorloc302 <code> <url>
2365 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2367 yes | yes | yes | yes
2368 Arguments :
2369 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002370 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002371
2372 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2373 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2374 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2375 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2376 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2377
2378 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2379 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2380 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2381
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002382 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002384 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2385 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2386 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2387 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2388 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2389 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2390 request.
2391
2392 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2393
2394
2395errorloc303 <code> <url>
2396 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 yes | yes | yes | yes
2399 Arguments :
2400 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2401 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2402
2403 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2404 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2405 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2406 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2407 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2408
2409 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2410 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2411 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2412
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002413 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2414
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002415 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2416 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2417 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2418 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002419 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002420
2421 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2422
2423
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002424force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2425 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 no | yes | yes | yes
2428
2429 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2430 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2431 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2432 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2433 marked down for maintenance operations.
2434
2435 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2436 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2437 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2438 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2439 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2440 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2441 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2442 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2443 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2444
2445 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2446 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2447 is used.
2448
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002449 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002450 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002451
2452
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002453fullconn <conns>
2454 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2456 yes | no | yes | yes
2457 Arguments :
2458 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2459 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2460
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002461 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002462 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002463 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002464 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2465 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2466 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2467 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2468 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002469 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002470
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002471 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2472 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2473 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002475 Example :
2476 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2477 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2478 # connections.
2479 backend dynamic
2480 fullconn 10000
2481 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2482 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2483
2484 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2485
2486
2487grace <time>
2488 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002490 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002491 Arguments :
2492 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2493 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2494 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2495
2496 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2497 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002498 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002499 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2500
2501 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2502 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2503 simplify it.
2504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002506hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002507 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2509 yes | no | yes | yes
2510 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002511 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2512 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002513
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002514 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2515 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2516 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2517 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2518 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2519 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2520 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2521 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2522 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2523 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002524
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002525 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2526 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2527 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2528 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2529 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2530 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2531 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2532 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2533 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2534 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2535 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2536 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2537 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002538 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2539 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002540
2541 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2542
2543 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2544 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2545 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2546 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002547 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2548 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2549 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002550
2551 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2552 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002553 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2554 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2555 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2556 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2557
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002558 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2559 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2560 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2561 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2562 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2563 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2564 parameter.
2565
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002566 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2567
2568 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2569 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2570 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2571 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2572 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2573 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2574 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2575 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2576 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2577 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2578 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2579 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002580
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002581 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2582 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2583 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002584
2585 See also : "balance", "server"
2586
2587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588http-check disable-on-404
2589 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592 Arguments : none
2593
2594 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2595 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2596 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2597 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2598 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2599 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2600 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2601 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002602 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2603 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2604 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2605
2606 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2607
2608
2609http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002610 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002612 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002613 Arguments :
2614 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2615 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002616 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002617 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2618 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2619 details on the supported keywords.
2620
2621 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2622 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2623 with the usual backslash ('\').
2624
2625 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2626 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2627 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2628 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2629 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2630
2631 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002632 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002633 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2634 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2635 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2636
2637 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002639 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2640 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2641 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2642 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2643
2644 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002645 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002646 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2647 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2648 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2649 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2650 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2651 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2652 trace).
2653
2654 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002655 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002656 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2657 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2658 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2659 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2660 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2661 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2662
2663 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2664 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2665 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2666 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2667 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2668 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2669 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2670 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2671
2672 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2673 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2674
2675 Examples :
2676 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002677 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002678
2679 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002680 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002681
2682 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002683 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002684
2685 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002686 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002688 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002689
2690
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002691http-check send-state
2692 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2694 yes | no | yes | yes
2695 Arguments : none
2696
2697 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2698 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2699 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2700 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2701 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2702
2703 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2704 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2705 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2706 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2707 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2708 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2709 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2710 checked in multiple backends.
2711
2712 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2713 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2714
2715 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2716 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2717 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2718 one fails.
2719
2720 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2721 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2722 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2723
2724 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2725 server's queue.
2726
2727 Example of a header received by the application server :
2728 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2729 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2730
2731 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2732
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002733http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002734 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002735 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2736 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002738 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2739
2740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2741 no | yes | yes | yes
2742
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002743 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2744 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2745 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2746 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2747 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002748
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002749 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2750 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2751 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2752
2753 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2754 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2755 are evaluated.
2756
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002757 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2758 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2759 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2760 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2761 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2762 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2763 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2764 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2765 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2766 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2767 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002769 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2770 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2771 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2772 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2773 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2774
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002775 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2776 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2777 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002778 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2779 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002780
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002781 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2782 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2783 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2784 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2785 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2786 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2787 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2788 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2789
2790 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2791 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2792 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2793 external users.
2794
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002795 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2796 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2797 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2798 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2799 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2800 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2801 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2802 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2803
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002804 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2805 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2806 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2807 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2808 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2809 another equipment.
2810
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002811 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2812 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2813 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2814 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2815 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2816 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2817 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2818 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2819
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002820 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2821 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2822 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2823 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2824 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2825 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2826 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2827 admin privileges.
2828
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002829 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2830
2831 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2832 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2833 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2834 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002835
2836 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002837 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2838 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2839 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002840
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002841 http-request allow if nagios
2842 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2843 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2844 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002845
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002846 Example:
2847 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002848 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002849
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002850 Example:
2851 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2852 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2853 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2854 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2855 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2856 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2857 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2858 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2859 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2860
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002861 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2862 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002863
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002864http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002865 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002866 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2867 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002868 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2869
2870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 no | yes | yes | yes
2872
2873 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2874 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2875 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2876 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2877 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2878 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2879
2880 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2881 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2882 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2883 current section.
2884
2885 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2886 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2887 rules are evaluated.
2888
2889 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2890 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2891 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2892 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2893 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2894 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2895 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2896
2897 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2898 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2899 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2900 external users.
2901
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002902 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2903 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2904 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2905 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2906 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2907 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2908 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2909 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2910
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002911 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2912 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2913 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2914 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2915 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2916 another equipment.
2917
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002918 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2919 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2920 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2921 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2922 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2923 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2924 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2925 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2926
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002927 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2928 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2929 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2930 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2931 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2932 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2933 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2934 admin privileges.
2935
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002936 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2937
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002938 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002939 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2940 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2941 rules.
2942
2943 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2944 ACL usage.
2945
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002946
2947tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2948 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2950 no | no | yes | yes
2951
2952 Arguments :
2953 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2954 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2955 binary.
2956 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2957 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2958 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2959
2960 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2961 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2962 with the usual backslash ('\').
2963 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2964 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2965 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2966 used upper or lower case.
2967
2968
2969 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
2970
2971 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
2972 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2973 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
2974 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2975 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2976 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
2977 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
2978 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
2979
2980 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
2981 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2982 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
2983 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2984 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
2985 expression.
2986
2987 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
2988 in the response buffer. A health check response will
2989 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
2990 this exact hexadecimal string.
2991 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
2992
2993 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2994 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2995 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2996 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
2997 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2998 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2999 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3000 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3001 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3002 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3003 the null character.
3004
3005 Examples :
3006 # perform a POP check
3007 option tcp-check
3008 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3009
3010 # perform an IMAP check
3011 option tcp-check
3012 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3013
3014 # look for the redis master server
3015 option tcp-check
3016 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3017 tcp-check expect +PONG
3018 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3019 tcp-check expect string role:master
3020 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3021 tcp-check expect string +OK
3022
3023
3024 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3025 tune.chksize
3026
3027
3028tcp-check send <data>
3029 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3031 no | no | yes | yes
3032
3033 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3034 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3035
3036 Examples :
3037 # look for the redis master server
3038 option tcp-check
3039 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3040 tcp-check expect string role:master
3041
3042 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3043 tune.chksize
3044
3045
3046tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3047 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3048 tcp health check
3049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 no | no | yes | yes
3051
3052 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3053 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3054 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3055 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3056 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3057 hexadecimal string.
3058 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3059
3060 Examples :
3061 # redis check in binary
3062 option tcp-check
3063 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3064 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3065
3066
3067 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3068 tune.chksize
3069
3070
3071
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003072http-send-name-header [<header>]
3073 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3074
3075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | no | yes | yes
3077
3078 Arguments :
3079
3080 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3081
3082 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3083 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3084 is added with the header string proved.
3085
3086 See also : "server"
3087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003088id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003089 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 no | yes | yes | yes
3092 Arguments : none
3093
3094 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3095 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3096 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003097
3098
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003099ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3100 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3102 no | yes | yes | yes
3103
3104 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3105 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3106 and running).
3107
3108 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3109 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3110 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3111 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3112 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3113
3114 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3115 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3116
3117 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3118 "unless" condition is met.
3119
3120 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3121
3122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003123log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003124log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003125no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003126 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003129
3130 Prefix :
3131 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3132 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3133 prefix does not allow arguments.
3134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003135 Arguments :
3136 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3137 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3138 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3139 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3140 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3141 parameter.
3142
3143 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3144 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3145
3146 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3147 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3148 standard syslog port).
3149
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003150 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3151 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3152 standard syslog port).
3153
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003154 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3155 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3156 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3157 appropriately writeable).
3158
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003159 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3160 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3161 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3162 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3163
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003164 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3165
3166 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3167 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3168 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3169
3170 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3171 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3172 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003173 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3174 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3175 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3176 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3177 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178
3179 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3180
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003181 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3182 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3183 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003184
3185 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3186 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3187 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3188 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3189
3190 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3191 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003192
3193 Example :
3194 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003195 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3196 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003197 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3198
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003199
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003200log-format <string>
3201 Allows you to custom a log line.
3202
3203 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3204
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003205
3206maxconn <conns>
3207 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 yes | yes | yes | no
3210 Arguments :
3211 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3212 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3213 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3214 closes.
3215
3216 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3217 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3218 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3219 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3220 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3221 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3222 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3223 properly tuned.
3224
3225 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3226 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3227 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3228
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003229 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003231 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3232
3233
3234mode { tcp|http|health }
3235 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3237 yes | yes | yes | yes
3238 Arguments :
3239 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3240 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3241 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3242 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3243
3244 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3245 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3246 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3247 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3248 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3249
3250 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003251 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3252 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3253 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3254 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3255 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3256 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3257 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003258
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003259 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3260 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3261 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003263 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 defaults http_instances
3265 mode http
3266
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003267 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003270monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003271 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3273 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274 Arguments :
3275 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3276 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003277 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3279 backend and its backup.
3280
3281 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3282 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3283 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3284 servers in a list of backends.
3285
3286 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3287 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3288 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3289 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3290 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3291 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3292 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003293 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3294 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295
3296 Example:
3297 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003298 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3300 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3301 monitor-uri /site_alive
3302 monitor fail if site_dead
3303
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003304 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003305
3306
3307monitor-net <source>
3308 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3310 yes | yes | yes | no
3311 Arguments :
3312 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3313 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3314 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3315 followed by a mask.
3316
3317 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3318 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003319 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003320 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3321
3322 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3323 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3324 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3325 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003326 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3327 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3328 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003330 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3331 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3332 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3333 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3334 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3335 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003336
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003337 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3338 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003339
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003340 Example :
3341 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3342 frontend www
3343 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3344
3345 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3346
3347
3348monitor-uri <uri>
3349 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | yes | yes | no
3352 Arguments :
3353 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3354 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3355
3356 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3357 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3358 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3359 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3360 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3361 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3362 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3363 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3364
3365 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3366 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3367 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3368 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3369 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3370 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3371
3372 Example :
3373 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3374 frontend www
3375 mode http
3376 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3377
3378 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003381option abortonclose
3382no option abortonclose
3383 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | no | yes | yes
3386 Arguments : none
3387
3388 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3389 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3390 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3391 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003392 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003393 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3394 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3395 encountered while delivering the response.
3396
3397 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3398 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3399 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3400 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3401 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3402 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003403 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003404 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003405 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003406 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3407 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3408 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3409
3410 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3411 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3412 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3413 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3414 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3415 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3416 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3417 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003418 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003419
3420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3422
3423 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3424
3425
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003426option accept-invalid-http-request
3427no option accept-invalid-http-request
3428 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | yes | yes | no
3431 Arguments : none
3432
3433 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3434 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3435 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3436 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3437 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3438 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3439 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3440 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003441 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3442 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3443 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3444 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3445 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3446 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003447
3448 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3449 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3450 been confirmed.
3451
3452 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3453 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003454 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3455 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003456 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3457
3458 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3459 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3460
3461 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3462 stats socket.
3463
3464
3465option accept-invalid-http-response
3466no option accept-invalid-http-response
3467 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3469 yes | no | yes | yes
3470 Arguments : none
3471
3472 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3473 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3474 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3475 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3476 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3477 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3478 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3479 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3480 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3481
3482 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3483 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3484 been confirmed.
3485
3486 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3487 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3488 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3489 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3490
3491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3493
3494 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3495 stats socket.
3496
3497
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003498option allbackups
3499no option allbackups
3500 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 yes | no | yes | yes
3503 Arguments : none
3504
3505 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3506 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3507 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3508 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3509 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3510 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3511 order between the backup servers anymore.
3512
3513 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3514 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3515
3516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3518
3519
3520option checkcache
3521no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003522 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 yes | no | yes | yes
3525 Arguments : none
3526
3527 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3528 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003529 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003530 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3531 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003532 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003533
3534 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003535 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003536 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003537 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3538 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003539 to the client are :
3540 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003541 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003542 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003543 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3544 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3545 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3546 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3547 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3548 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3549 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3550 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3551 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3552 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3553 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3554
3555 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003556 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003558 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003559 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3560
3561 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3562 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003563 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003564 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3565
3566 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3567 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3568
3569
3570option clitcpka
3571no option clitcpka
3572 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3574 yes | yes | yes | no
3575 Arguments : none
3576
3577 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3578 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3579 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3580 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3581
3582 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3583 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3584 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3585 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3586
3587 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3588 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3589 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3590 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3591 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3592
3593 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3594
3595 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3596 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3597 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3598
3599 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3600 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3601
3602 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3603
3604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605option contstats
3606 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | yes | yes | no
3609 Arguments : none
3610
3611 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3612 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3613 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3614 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3615 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3616 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3617 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3618
3619
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003620option dontlog-normal
3621no option dontlog-normal
3622 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | no
3625 Arguments : none
3626
3627 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3628 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3629 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3630 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3631 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3632 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3633 logged.
3634
3635 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3636 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3637 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003639 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003640 logging.
3641
3642
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003643option dontlognull
3644no option dontlognull
3645 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | yes | yes | no
3648 Arguments : none
3649
3650 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3651 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3652 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3653 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3654 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3655 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3656 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3657
3658 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3659 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3660 would not be logged.
3661
3662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003665 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003666
3667
3668option forceclose
3669no option forceclose
3670 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003673 Arguments : none
3674
3675 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3676 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3677 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3678 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3679 global session times in the logs.
3680
3681 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003682 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003683 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3684 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3685 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3686 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003688 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3689 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3690 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3691
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3694
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003695 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003696
3697
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003698option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | yes | yes | yes
3702 Arguments :
3703 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3704 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003705 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003706 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003707
3708 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3709 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3710 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3711 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3712 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3713 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3714 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003715 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3716 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3717 possible that the client has already brought one.
3718
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003719 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003720 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003721 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3722 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003723 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3724 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003725
3726 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3727 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3728 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3729 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3730 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3731 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3732 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3733
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003734 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3735 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3736 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3737 are under the control of the end-user.
3738
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003739 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003740 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3741 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003742 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3743 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3744 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003745
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003746 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3747 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3748 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3749 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3750 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003751
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003752 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003753 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3754 frontend www
3755 mode http
3756 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3757
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003758 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3759 backend www
3760 mode http
3761 option forwardfor header X-Client
3762
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003763 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3764 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003765
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003766
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003767option http-keep-alive
3768no option http-keep-alive
3769 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments : none
3773
3774 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3775 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3776 "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client- and
3777 server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3778 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3779 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3780 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3781 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3782 situations where this option may be useful :
3783
3784 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3785 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3786
3787 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3788 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3789
3790 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3791 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3792 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3793 request.
3794
3795 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3796 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
3797 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened.
3798
3799 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3800 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3801
3802 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3803 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3804 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3805 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3806 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3807 not set.
3808
3809 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3810 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3811 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3812 have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
3813
3814 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3815 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3816
3817 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
3818 "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
3819 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
3820
3821
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003822option http-no-delay
3823no option http-no-delay
3824 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827 Arguments : none
3828
3829 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3830 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3831 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3832 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3833 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3834 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3835 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3836 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3837 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3838 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3839 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3840 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3841 affected.
3842
3843 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3844 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3845 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3846 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3847 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3848 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3849 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3850 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3851 latency environments.
3852
3853
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003854option http-pretend-keepalive
3855no option http-pretend-keepalive
3856 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | yes | yes | yes
3859 Arguments : none
3860
3861 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3862 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3863 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3864 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3865 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3866 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3867 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3868 consider the response complete.
3869
3870 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3871 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3872 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3873 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3874 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3875 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3876
3877 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3878 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3879 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3880 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3881 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3882 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3883 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3884
3885 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3886 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003887 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003888 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3889 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003890
3891 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3892 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3893
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003894 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3895 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003896
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003897
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003898option http-server-close
3899no option http-server-close
3900 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | yes | yes | yes
3903 Arguments : none
3904
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003905 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3906 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3907 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3908 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3909 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3910 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3911 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3912 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3913 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3914 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3915 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3916 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003917
3918 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3919 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3920 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3921 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003922 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3923 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003924
3925 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3926 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003927 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3928 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3929 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003930
3931 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3932 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3933
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003934 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003935 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3936 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003937
3938
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003939option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003940no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003941 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | yes | yes | no
3944 Arguments : none
3945
3946 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3947 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3948 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3949 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3950 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3951 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3952 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3953
3954 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3955 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3956 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3957 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3958 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3959 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3960 request along its whole life.
3961
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003962 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3963 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3964 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3965 front of an existing proxy.
3966
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003967 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3968
3969 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3970 http-server-close".
3971
3972
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003973option httpchk
3974option httpchk <uri>
3975option httpchk <method> <uri>
3976option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3977 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 yes | no | yes | yes
3980 Arguments :
3981 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3982 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3983 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3984 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3985 ones.
3986
3987 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3988 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3989 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3990
3991 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3992 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3993 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3994 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3995 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3996
3997 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3998 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3999 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4000 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4001 the lack of any response.
4002
4003 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4004
4005 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4006 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4007 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4008
4009 Examples :
4010 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4011 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4012 backend https_relay
4013 mode tcp
4014 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4015 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4016
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004017 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4018 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4019 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004020
4021
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004022option httpclose
4023no option httpclose
4024 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4026 yes | yes | yes | yes
4027 Arguments : none
4028
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004029 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4030 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4031 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4032 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4033 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4034 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4035 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004036
4037 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004038 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004039 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4040 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4041 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4042 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4043 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004044
4045 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4046 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
4047 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004048 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
4049 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004050
4051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4053
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004054 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4055 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004056
4057
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004058option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004059 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004062 Arguments :
4063 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4064 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4065 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4066 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4067 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004068
4069 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4070 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4071 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4072 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4073 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4074 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4075 ports.
4076
4077 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4078
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4081 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4082 by default.
4083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004084 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004085
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004086
4087option http_proxy
4088no option http_proxy
4089 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4091 yes | yes | yes | yes
4092 Arguments : none
4093
4094 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4095 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4096 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4097 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4098 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4099
4100 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4101 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4102 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4103 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004104 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004105 be analyzed.
4106
4107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4109
4110 Example :
4111 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4112 backend direct_forward
4113 option httpclose
4114 option http_proxy
4115
4116 See also : "option httpclose"
4117
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004118
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004119option independent-streams
4120no option independent-streams
4121 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | yes | yes | yes
4124 Arguments : none
4125
4126 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4127 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4128 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4129 receive data or not.
4130
4131 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4132 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4133 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4134 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4135 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4136 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4137 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4138 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4139 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4140 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4141 socket buffers.
4142
4143 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4144 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4145 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4146 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4147 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4148
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004149 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4150 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4151 deprecated.
4152
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004153 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004154
4155
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004156option ldap-check
4157 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4159 yes | no | yes | yes
4160 Arguments : none
4161
4162 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4163 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4164 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4165 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4166
4167 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4168 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4169
4170 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4171 configure it.
4172
4173 Example :
4174 option ldap-check
4175
4176 See also : "option httpchk"
4177
4178
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004179option log-health-checks
4180no option log-health-checks
4181 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4183 yes | no | yes | yes
4184 Arguments : none
4185
4186 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4187 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4188 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4189 of additional information is limited.
4190
4191 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4192 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4193
4194 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4195
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004196
4197option log-separate-errors
4198no option log-separate-errors
4199 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4201 yes | yes | yes | no
4202 Arguments : none
4203
4204 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4205 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4206 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4207 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4208 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4209 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4210 provides very important information.
4211
4212 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4213 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4214 error logs.
4215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004216 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004217 logging.
4218
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004219
4220option logasap
4221no option logasap
4222 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | yes | yes | no
4225 Arguments : none
4226
4227 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4228 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4229 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4230 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4231 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4232 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4233 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004234 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004235 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4236 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4237
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004238 Examples :
4239 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4240 mode http
4241 option httplog
4242 option logasap
4243 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4244
4245 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4246 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4247 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4248 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004250 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004251 logging.
4252
4253
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004254option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4255 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4257 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004258 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004259 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4260 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004261
4262 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4263 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4264 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4265 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4266 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4267 in the MySQL table, like this :
4268
4269 USE mysql;
4270 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4271 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4272
4273 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4274 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4275 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4276 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4277 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4278 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4279 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4280 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4281 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4282
4283 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4284 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004285
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004286 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004287
4288 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4289 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4290 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4291 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4292 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4293 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4294
4295 See also: "option httpchk"
4296
4297
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004298option nolinger
4299no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004300 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4302 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004303 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004304
4305 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4306 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4307 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4308 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4309 connections.
4310
4311 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4312 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4313 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4314 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4315 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4316 this too.
4317
4318 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4319 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4320 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4321
4322 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4323 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4324 for servers.
4325
4326 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4327 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4328
4329
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004330option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4331 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | yes
4334 Arguments :
4335 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4336 matching <network>
4337 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4338 header name.
4339
4340 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4341 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4342 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4343 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4344 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4345 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4346 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4347 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4348 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4349 possible that the client has already brought one.
4350
4351 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4352 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4353 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4354 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4355 header and requires different one.
4356
4357 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4358 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4359 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4360 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4361 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4362 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4363 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4364
4365 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4366 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4367 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4368 both are defined.
4369
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004370 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4371 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4372 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4373 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4374 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004375
4376 Examples :
4377 # Original Destination address
4378 frontend www
4379 mode http
4380 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4381
4382 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4383 backend www
4384 mode http
4385 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4386
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004387 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4388 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004389
4390
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004391option persist
4392no option persist
4393 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004396 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004397
4398 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4399 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4400 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4401 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4402 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4403 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4404 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4405 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4406 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4407 redirected to another valid server.
4408
4409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4411
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004412 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004413
4414
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004415option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4416 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | no | yes | yes
4419 Arguments :
4420 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4421 PostgreSQL server.
4422
4423 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4424 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4425 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4426 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4427
4428 See also: "option httpchk"
4429
4430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004431option redispatch
4432no option redispatch
4433 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4435 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004436 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004437
4438 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4439 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4440 be able to access the service anymore.
4441
4442 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4443 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4444
4445 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4446 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4447 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004449 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4450 "redisp" keywords.
4451
4452 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4453 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4454
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004455 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004456
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004457
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004458option redis-check
4459 Use redis health checks for server testing
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | no | yes | yes
4462 Arguments : none
4463
4464 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4465 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4466 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4467 find the "+PONG" response message.
4468
4469 Example :
4470 option redis-check
4471
4472 See also : "option httpchk"
4473
4474
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004475option smtpchk
4476option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4477 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004480 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004481 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4482 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4483 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4484
4485 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4486 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4487 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4488
4489 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4490 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4491 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4492 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4493 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4494 dead server.
4495
4496 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4497 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4498 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4499 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4500
4501 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4502 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4503 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4504 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4505 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4506
4507 Example :
4508 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4509
4510 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004513option socket-stats
4514no option socket-stats
4515
4516 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4518 yes | yes | yes | no
4519
4520 Arguments : none
4521
4522
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004523option splice-auto
4524no option splice-auto
4525 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | yes | yes | yes
4528 Arguments : none
4529
4530 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4531 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4532 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4533 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004534 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004535 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4536 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4537 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4538 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4539
4540 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4541 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4542 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4543 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4544 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4545 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4546 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4547 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4548 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4549 keyword.
4550
4551 Example :
4552 option splice-auto
4553
4554 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4555 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4556
4557 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4558 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4559
4560
4561option splice-request
4562no option splice-request
4563 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4565 yes | yes | yes | yes
4566 Arguments : none
4567
4568 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004569 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004570 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4571 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4572 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4573 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4574
4575 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4576
4577 Example :
4578 option splice-request
4579
4580 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4581 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4582
4583 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4584 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4585
4586
4587option splice-response
4588no option splice-response
4589 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4591 yes | yes | yes | yes
4592 Arguments : none
4593
4594 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004595 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004596 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4597 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4598 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4599 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4600
4601 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4602
4603 Example :
4604 option splice-response
4605
4606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4608
4609 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4610 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4611
4612
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004613option srvtcpka
4614no option srvtcpka
4615 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4617 yes | no | yes | yes
4618 Arguments : none
4619
4620 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4621 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4622 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4623 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4624
4625 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4626 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4627 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4628 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4629
4630 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4631 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4632 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4633 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4634 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4635
4636 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4637
4638 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4639 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4640 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4641
4642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4644
4645 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4646
4647
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004648option ssl-hello-chk
4649 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 yes | no | yes | yes
4652 Arguments : none
4653
4654 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4655 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4656 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4657 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4658 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4659 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4660 hello message.
4661
4662 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4663 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4664 messages, which is appreciable.
4665
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004666 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4667 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4668 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004669
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004670 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4671
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004672
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004673option tcp-check
4674 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 yes | no | yes | yes
4677
4678 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4679 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4680
4681 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4682 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4683 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4684
4685 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4686 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4687 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4688 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4689 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4690 only.
4691
4692 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4693 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4694 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4695 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4696 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4697
4698 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4699 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4700 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4701 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4702 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4703 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4704 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4705 the respective protocols.
4706 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4707 analysed.
4708
4709 Examples :
4710 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4711 option tcp-check
4712 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4713
4714 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4715 option tcp-check
4716 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4717
4718 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4719 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4720 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4721 option tcp-check
4722 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4723 tcp-check expect +PONG
4724 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4725 tcp-check expect string role:master
4726 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4727 tcp-check expect string +OK
4728
4729 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4730 (send many headers before analyzing)
4731 option tcp-check
4732 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4733 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4734 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4735 tcp-check send \r\n
4736 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4737
4738
4739 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4740
4741
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004742option tcp-smart-accept
4743no option tcp-smart-accept
4744 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 yes | yes | yes | no
4747 Arguments : none
4748
4749 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4750 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4751 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4752 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4753 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4754 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4755
4756 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4757 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4758 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4759 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4760
4761 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4762 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4763 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4764 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4765
4766 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4767 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4768 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4769
4770 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4771 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4772 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4773
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004774 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4775
4776
4777option tcp-smart-connect
4778no option tcp-smart-connect
4779 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782 Arguments : none
4783
4784 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4785 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4786 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4787 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4788 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4789
4790 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4791 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4792 complex.
4793
4794 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4795 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4796 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4797
4798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4800
4801 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4802
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004803
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004804option tcpka
4805 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments : none
4809
4810 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4811 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4812 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4813 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4814
4815 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4816 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4817 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4818 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4819
4820 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4821 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4822 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4823 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4824 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4825
4826 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4827
4828 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4829 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4830 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4831 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4832 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4833 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4834 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4835 backends.
4836
4837 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4838
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004839
4840option tcplog
4841 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 yes | yes | yes | yes
4844 Arguments : none
4845
4846 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4847 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4848 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4849 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4850 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4851 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4852 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4853 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4854
4855 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004857 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004858
4859
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004860option transparent
4861no option transparent
4862 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004864 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004865 Arguments : none
4866
4867 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4868 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4869 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4870 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4871 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4872 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4873 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4874 appropriate server.
4875
4876 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4877 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4878
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004879 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004880 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004881
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004882
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004883persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004884persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004885 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | no | yes | yes
4888 Arguments :
4889 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004890 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4891 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004892
4893 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4894 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4895 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4896 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4897 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4898 forwarded to this server.
4899
4900 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4901 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4902 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004903 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004904 a single "listen" section.
4905
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004906 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4907 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4908 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4909
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004910 Example :
4911 listen tse-farm
4912 bind :3389
4913 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4914 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4915 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4916 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4917 persist rdp-cookie
4918 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004919 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004920 balance rdp-cookie
4921 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4922 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4923
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004924 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4925 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004926
4927
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004928rate-limit sessions <rate>
4929 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 yes | yes | yes | no
4932 Arguments :
4933 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4934 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4935
4936 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4937 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4938 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4939 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4940 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4941 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4942
4943 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4944 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4945 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4946 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4947
4948 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4949 listen smtp
4950 mode tcp
4951 bind :25
4952 rate-limit sessions 10
4953 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4954
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004955 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4956 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4957 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004958
4959 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4960
4961
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004962redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4963redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4964redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004965 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4967 no | yes | yes | yes
4968
4969 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004970 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004971
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004972 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004973 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004974 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
4975 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
4976 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004977
4978 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4979 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4980 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4981 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4982 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004983 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
4984 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
4985 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
4986 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004987
4988 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4989 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4990 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4991 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4992 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4993 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4994 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4995 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004996 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
4997 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
4998 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004999
5000 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005001 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5002 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5003 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5004 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5005 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5006 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5007 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5008 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005009
5010 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5011 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5012
5013 - "drop-query"
5014 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5015 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5016 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5017 with a location-type redirect.
5018
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005019 - "append-slash"
5020 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5021 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5022 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5023 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5024
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005025 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5026 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5027 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5028 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5029 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5030 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5031 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5032
5033 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5034 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5035 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5036 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5037 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5038 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5039 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005040
5041 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5042 acl clear dst_port 80
5043 acl secure dst_port 8080
5044 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005045 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005046 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005047 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5048
5049 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005050 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5051 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5052 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005053 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005054
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005055 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5056 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5057 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5058
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005059 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005060 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005061
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005062 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5063 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5064 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005066 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005067
5068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005069redisp (deprecated)
5070redispatch (deprecated)
5071 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5072 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005074 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005075
5076 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5077 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5078 be able to access the service anymore.
5079
5080 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5081 redistribute them to a working server.
5082
5083 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5084 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5085 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005087 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5088 "option redispatch" instead.
5089
5090 See also : "option redispatch"
5091
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005092
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005093reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005094 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 no | yes | yes | yes
5097 Arguments :
5098 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5099 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005100 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005101
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005102 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5103 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5104
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005105 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5106 the last header of an HTTP request.
5107
5108 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5109 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5110 responses.
5111
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005112 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5113 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5114 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5115
5116 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5117 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005118
5119
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005120reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5121reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005122 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5124 no | yes | yes | yes
5125 Arguments :
5126 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5127 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5128 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5129 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5130 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5131 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5132 ignores case.
5133
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005134 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5135 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5136
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005137 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5138 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5139 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5140 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005141 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005142
5143 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5144 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5145
5146 Example :
5147 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5148 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5149 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5150
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005151 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5152 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005153
5154
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005155reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5156reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005157 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5159 no | yes | yes | yes
5160 Arguments :
5161 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5162 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5163 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5164 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5165 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5166 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5167
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005168 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5169 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5170
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005171 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5172 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5173 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5174 next servers.
5175
5176 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5177 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5178 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5179
5180 Example :
5181 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5182 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5183 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5184
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005185 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5186 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005187
5188
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005189reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5190reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005191 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 no | yes | yes | yes
5194 Arguments :
5195 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5196 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5197 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5198 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5199 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5200 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5201 case.
5202
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005203 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5204 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5205
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005206 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5207 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5208 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5209 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005210 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005211
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005212 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005213 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005214 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005215
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005216 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5217 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5218
5219 Example :
5220 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5221 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5222 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005224 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5225 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005226
5227
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005228reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5229reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005230 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 no | yes | yes | yes
5233 Arguments :
5234 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5235 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5236 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5237 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5238 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5239 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5240 case.
5241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005242 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5243 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005245 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5246 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5247 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5248 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5249
5250 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5251 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5252
5253 Example :
5254 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5255 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5256 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5257 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005259 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5260 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005261
5262
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005263reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5264reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005265 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 no | yes | yes | yes
5268 Arguments :
5269 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5270 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5271 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5272 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5273 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5274 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5275
5276 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5277 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5278 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5279 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005280 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005281
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005282 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5283 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5284
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005285 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5286 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5287 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5288
5289 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5290 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5291 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5292 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5293 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5294
5295 Example :
5296 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005297 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005298 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5299 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5300
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005301 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5302 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005303
5304
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005305reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5306reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005307 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5309 no | yes | yes | yes
5310 Arguments :
5311 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5312 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5313 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5314 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5315 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5316 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5317 ignores case.
5318
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005319 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5320 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5321
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005322 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5323 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005324 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5325 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5326 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005327 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5328 not set.
5329
5330 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5331 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5332 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5333 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5334 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5335
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005336 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5338 # block all others.
5339 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5340 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5341
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005342 # block bad guys
5343 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5344 reqitarpit . if badguys
5345
5346 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5347 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005348
5349
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005350retries <value>
5351 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5353 yes | no | yes | yes
5354 Arguments :
5355 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5356 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5357 default value is 3.
5358
5359 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5360 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5361 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5362
5363 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5364 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5365
5366 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5367 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5368
5369 See also : "option redispatch"
5370
5371
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005372rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005373 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5375 no | yes | yes | yes
5376 Arguments :
5377 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5378 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005379 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005380
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005381 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5382 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5383
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005384 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5385 the last header of an HTTP response.
5386
5387 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5388 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5389 responses.
5390
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005391 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5392 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005393
5394
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005395rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5396rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005397 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5399 no | yes | yes | yes
5400 Arguments :
5401 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5402 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5403 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5404 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5405 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5406 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5407 ignores case.
5408
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005409 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5410 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5411
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005412 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5413 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005414 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005415 client.
5416
5417 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5418 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5419 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5420
5421 Example :
5422 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005423 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005424
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005425 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5426 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005427
5428
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005429rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5430rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005431 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5433 no | yes | yes | yes
5434 Arguments :
5435 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5436 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5437 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5438 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5439 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5440 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5441 ignores case.
5442
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005443 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5444 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5445
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005446 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5447 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5448 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5449 case-sensitive.
5450
5451 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005452 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5453 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5454 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005455
5456 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5457 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5458
5459 Example :
5460 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5461 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5462
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005463 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5464 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005465
5466
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005467rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5468rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005469 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5471 no | yes | yes | yes
5472 Arguments :
5473 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5474 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5475 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5476 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5477 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5478 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5479 ignores case.
5480
5481 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5482 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5483 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5484 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005485 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005487 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5488 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5489
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005490 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5491 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5492 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5493
5494 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5495 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5496 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5497 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5498 are not case-sensitive.
5499
5500 Example :
5501 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5502 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5503
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005504 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5505 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005506
5507
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005508server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005509 Declare a server in a backend
5510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5511 no | no | yes | yes
5512 Arguments :
5513 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005514 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005515 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005516
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005517 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5518 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5519 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5520 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005521 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5522 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5523 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5524 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5525 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005526 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5527 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5528 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5529 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5530 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5531 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5532 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005533 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5534 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5535 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5536 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005537
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005538 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005539 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5540 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5541 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5542 adding this value to the client's port.
5543
5544 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5545 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005546 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005547
5548 Examples :
5549 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5550 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005551 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005552 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5553 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5554 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005555
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005556 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5557 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005558
5559
5560source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005561source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005562source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005563 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | no | yes | yes
5566 Arguments :
5567 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5568 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005569
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005570 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005571 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5572 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5573 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5574 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5575 supported prefixes are :
5576 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5577 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5578 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005579 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5580 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5581 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5582 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005583
5584 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5585 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005586 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5587 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5588 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005589
5590 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5591 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5592 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5593 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5594 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5595 <addr>.
5596
5597 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5598 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5599 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5600 port.
5601
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005602 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5603 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5604 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5605 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005606 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005607 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5608 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5609 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5610 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5611 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5612 HTTP header.
5613
5614 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5615 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005616 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005617 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5618 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5619 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5620 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5621 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5622 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5623 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5624
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005625 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5626 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5627 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5628 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5629 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5630 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5631
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005632 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5633 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5634 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5635 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5636
5637 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5638 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5639 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5640 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5641 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5642 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5643
5644 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5645 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5646 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5647 there are two methods :
5648
5649 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5650 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5651 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5652 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5653 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5654 of the client ranges may be used.
5655
5656 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5657 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5658 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5659 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5660 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5661 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5662 same session.
5663
5664 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5665 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5666 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5667 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5668 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5669 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5670
5671 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5672 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5673 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005674 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005675
5676 Examples :
5677 backend private
5678 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5679 source 192.168.1.200
5680
5681 backend transparent_ssl1
5682 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5683 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5684
5685 backend transparent_ssl2
5686 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5687 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5688 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5689
5690 backend transparent_ssl3
5691 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5692 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5693 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5694
5695 backend transparent_smtp
5696 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5697 # with Tproxy version 4.
5698 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5699
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005700 backend transparent_http
5701 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5702 # proxy.
5703 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005705 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005706 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005708
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005709srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5710 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5712 yes | no | yes | yes
5713 Arguments :
5714 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5715 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5716 as explained at the top of this document.
5717
5718 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5719 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5720 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5721 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5722 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5723 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5724 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5725
5726 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5727 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5728 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5729 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5730 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005731 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005732 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005733 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005734
5735 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5737 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5738 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5739 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5740 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5741
5742 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5743 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5744
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005745 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5746 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005747
5748
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005749stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5750 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5752 no | no | yes | yes
5753
5754 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5755 matched.
5756
5757 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5758 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5759
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005760 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5761 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5762 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5763
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005764 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5765 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5766 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5767 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005768
5769 Example :
5770 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5771 backend stats_localhost
5772 stats enable
5773 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5774
5775 Example :
5776 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5777 backend stats_auth
5778 stats enable
5779 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5780 stats admin if TRUE
5781
5782 Example :
5783 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5784 userlist stats-auth
5785 group admin users admin
5786 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5787 group readonly users haproxy
5788 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5789
5790 backend stats_auth
5791 stats enable
5792 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5793 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5794 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5795 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5796
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005797 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5798 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5799 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005800
5801
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005802stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5803 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | no | yes | yes
5806 Arguments :
5807 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5808
5809 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5810
5811 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5812 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5813 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5814 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5815 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5816 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5817
5818 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5819 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5820 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005821 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005822
5823 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5824 report using "stats scope".
5825
5826 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5827 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5828 unobvious parameters.
5829
5830 Example :
5831 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5832 backend public_www
5833 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5834 stats enable
5835 stats hide-version
5836 stats scope .
5837 stats uri /admin?stats
5838 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5839 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5840 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5841
5842 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5843 backend private_monitoring
5844 stats enable
5845 stats uri /admin?stats
5846 stats refresh 5s
5847
5848 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5849
5850
5851stats enable
5852 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5854 yes | no | yes | yes
5855 Arguments : none
5856
5857 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5858 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5859 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5860 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5861 - stats auth : no authentication
5862 - stats scope : no restriction
5863
5864 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5865 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5866 unobvious parameters.
5867
5868 Example :
5869 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5870 backend public_www
5871 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5872 stats enable
5873 stats hide-version
5874 stats scope .
5875 stats uri /admin?stats
5876 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5877 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5878 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5879
5880 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5881 backend private_monitoring
5882 stats enable
5883 stats uri /admin?stats
5884 stats refresh 5s
5885
5886 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5887
5888
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005889stats hide-version
5890 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005893 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005895 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5896 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5897 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5898 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5899 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5900 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005902 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5903 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5904 unobvious parameters.
5905
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005906 Example :
5907 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5908 backend public_www
5909 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005910 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005911 stats hide-version
5912 stats scope .
5913 stats uri /admin?stats
5914 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5915 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5916 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005917
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005918 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5919 backend private_monitoring
5920 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005921 stats uri /admin?stats
5922 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005924 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005925
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005926
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005927stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5928 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5929 Access control for statistics
5930
5931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 no | no | yes | yes
5933
5934 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5935 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5936 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5937 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5938 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5939 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5940
5941 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5942 instance.
5943
5944 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5945 about ACL usage.
5946
5947
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005948stats realm <realm>
5949 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5951 yes | no | yes | yes
5952 Arguments :
5953 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5954 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5955 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5956
5957 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5958 using a backslash ('\').
5959
5960 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5961 only related to authentication.
5962
5963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5965 unobvious parameters.
5966
5967 Example :
5968 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5969 backend public_www
5970 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5971 stats enable
5972 stats hide-version
5973 stats scope .
5974 stats uri /admin?stats
5975 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5976 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5977 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5978
5979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5980 backend private_monitoring
5981 stats enable
5982 stats uri /admin?stats
5983 stats refresh 5s
5984
5985 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5986
5987
5988stats refresh <delay>
5989 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 yes | no | yes | yes
5992 Arguments :
5993 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5994 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5995 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5996 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5997 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5998 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5999
6000 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6001 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6002 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6003 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6004
6005 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6006 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6007 unobvious parameters.
6008
6009 Example :
6010 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6011 backend public_www
6012 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6013 stats enable
6014 stats hide-version
6015 stats scope .
6016 stats uri /admin?stats
6017 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6018 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6019 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6020
6021 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6022 backend private_monitoring
6023 stats enable
6024 stats uri /admin?stats
6025 stats refresh 5s
6026
6027 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6028
6029
6030stats scope { <name> | "." }
6031 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 yes | no | yes | yes
6034 Arguments :
6035 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6036 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6037 section in which the statement appears.
6038
6039 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6040 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6041 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6042 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6043 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6044 exists.
6045
6046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6048 unobvious parameters.
6049
6050 Example :
6051 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6052 backend public_www
6053 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6054 stats enable
6055 stats hide-version
6056 stats scope .
6057 stats uri /admin?stats
6058 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6059 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6060 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6061
6062 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6063 backend private_monitoring
6064 stats enable
6065 stats uri /admin?stats
6066 stats refresh 5s
6067
6068 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006070
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006071stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006072 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6074 yes | no | yes | yes
6075
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006076 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006077 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6078
6079 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6080 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6081
6082 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6083 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006084 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006085
6086 Example :
6087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6088 backend private_monitoring
6089 stats enable
6090 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6091 stats uri /admin?stats
6092 stats refresh 5s
6093
6094 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6095 global section.
6096
6097
6098stats show-legends
6099 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6100 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6101 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6102 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6103 - IP (socket, server)
6104 - cookie (backend, server)
6105
6106 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6107 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006108 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006109
6110 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6111
6112
6113stats show-node [ <name> ]
6114 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | no | yes | yes
6117 Arguments:
6118 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6119 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6120
6121 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6122 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006123 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006124
6125 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6126 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6127 unobvious parameters.
6128
6129 Example:
6130 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6131 backend private_monitoring
6132 stats enable
6133 stats show-node Europe-1
6134 stats uri /admin?stats
6135 stats refresh 5s
6136
6137 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6138 section.
6139
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006140
6141stats uri <prefix>
6142 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6144 yes | no | yes | yes
6145 Arguments :
6146 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6147 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6148 query string.
6149
6150 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6151 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6152 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6153 possible to reach it in the application.
6154
6155 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006156 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006157 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6158 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6159 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6160 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6161
6162 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6163 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6164 an address or a port to statistics only.
6165
6166 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6167 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6168 unobvious parameters.
6169
6170 Example :
6171 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6172 backend public_www
6173 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6174 stats enable
6175 stats hide-version
6176 stats scope .
6177 stats uri /admin?stats
6178 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6179 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6180 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6181
6182 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6183 backend private_monitoring
6184 stats enable
6185 stats uri /admin?stats
6186 stats refresh 5s
6187
6188 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6189
6190
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006191stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6192 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006194 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006195
6196 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006197 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006198 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6199 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6200 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6201
6202 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6203 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6204 the "stick-table" statement.
6205
6206 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6207 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6208 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6209 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6210 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6211
6212 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6213 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6214 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6215 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6216 transformation rules.
6217
6218 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6219 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6220 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6221 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6222 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6223 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6224 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6225
6226 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6227 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6228 ACL based conditions.
6229
6230 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6231 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6232 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6233 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6234
6235 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6236 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6237 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6238 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6239
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006240 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6241 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6242 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6243
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006244 Example :
6245 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6246 # last 30 minutes
6247 backend pop
6248 mode tcp
6249 balance roundrobin
6250 stick store-request src
6251 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6252 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6253 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6254
6255 backend smtp
6256 mode tcp
6257 balance roundrobin
6258 stick match src table pop
6259 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6260 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6261
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006262 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6263 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006264
6265
6266stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6267 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 no | no | yes | yes
6270
6271 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6272 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6273 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6274 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6275
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006276 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6277 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6278 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6279
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006280 Examples :
6281 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006282 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006283
6284 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6285 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6286 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6287
6288
6289 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6290 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6291 backend http
6292 mode http
6293 balance roundrobin
6294 stick on src table https
6295 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6296 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6297 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6298
6299 backend https
6300 mode tcp
6301 balance roundrobin
6302 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6303 stick on src
6304 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6305 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6306
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006307 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006308
6309
6310stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6311 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6313 no | no | yes | yes
6314
6315 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006316 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006317 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6318 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6319 server is selected.
6320
6321 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6322 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6323 the "stick-table" statement.
6324
6325 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6326 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6327 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6328 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6329 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6330 address.
6331
6332 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6333 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6334 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6335 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6336 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6337 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6338 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6339 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6340 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6341 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6342
6343 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6344 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6345 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6346 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6347 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6348 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6349 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6350
6351 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6352 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6353 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6354 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6355
6356 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6357 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6358 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6359 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6360 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6361 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006362 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6363 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6364 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6365 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6366 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6367 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006368
6369 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6370 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6371 the request.
6372
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006373 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6374 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6375 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6376
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006377 Example :
6378 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6379 # last 30 minutes
6380 backend pop
6381 mode tcp
6382 balance roundrobin
6383 stick store-request src
6384 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6385 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6386 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6387
6388 backend smtp
6389 mode tcp
6390 balance roundrobin
6391 stick match src table pop
6392 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6393 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6394
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006395 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6396 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006397
6398
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006399stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006400 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6401 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006402 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006404 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006405
6406 Arguments :
6407 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6408 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6409 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6410 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6411
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006412 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6413 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6414 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6415 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6416
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006417 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6418 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6419 instance.
6420
6421 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6422 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6423 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6424 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6425 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6426 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006427 to 32 characters.
6428
6429 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6430 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6431 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6432 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6433 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6434 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006435
6436 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006437 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6438 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006439 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6440 increase.
6441
6442 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006443 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6444 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6445 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006446
6447 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6448 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6449 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6450 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6451 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6452 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6453 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6454 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6455 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6456 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6457 parameter (see below).
6458
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006459 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6460 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6461 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6462 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6463 soft restart.
6464
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006465 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6466
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006467 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6468 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6469 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6470 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6471 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006472 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006473 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6474 if not expiration delay is specified.
6475
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006476 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6477 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6478 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6479 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006480 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6481 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6482 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6483 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6484 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6485 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6486 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6487 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6488 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6489 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6490 types and their arguments.
6491
6492 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6493 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6494 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6495 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6496
6497 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6498 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6499 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6500 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6501
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006502 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6503 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6504 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6505 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6506 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6507 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6508
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006509 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6510 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6511 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6512 they were received.
6513
6514 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6515 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6516 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6517 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6518 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6519
6520 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6521 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6522 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6523 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6524 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6525
6526 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6527 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6528 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6529
6530 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6531 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6532 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6533 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6534 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6535
6536 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6537 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6538 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6539 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6540 the client side.
6541
6542 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6543 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6544 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6545 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6546 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6547 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6548 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6549
6550 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6551 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6552 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6553 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6554 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6555 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6556 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6557
6558 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6559 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6560 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6561 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6562 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6563 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6564
6565 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6566 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6567 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6568 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6569
6570 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6571 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6572 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6573 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6574 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6575 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6576 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6577 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6578 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6579 recommended for better fairness.
6580
6581 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6582 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6583 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6584 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6585
6586 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6587 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6588 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6589 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6590 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6591 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6592 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6593 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6594 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6595 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006596
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006597 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6598 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006599 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6600 reference it.
6601
6602 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6603 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6604 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6605 as an exclusive stickiness.
6606
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006607 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6608 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6609 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6610 something that can be ignored.
6611
6612 Example:
6613 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6614 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6615 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6616 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6617
6618 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006619 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006620
6621
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006622stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6623 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6625 no | no | yes | yes
6626
6627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006628 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006629 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6630 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6631 server is selected.
6632
6633 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6634 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6635 the "stick-table" statement.
6636
6637 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6638 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6639 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6640 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6641
6642 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6643 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6644 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6645 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6646 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6647 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006648 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006649 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6650 rules.
6651
6652 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6653 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6654 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6655 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6656 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6657 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6658 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6659
6660 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6661 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6662 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6663 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6664
6665 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6666 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6667 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6668 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6669 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6670 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006671 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6672 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6673 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6674 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6675 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6676 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6677 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6678 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6679 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006680
6681 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6682
6683 Example :
6684 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6685 backend https
6686 mode tcp
6687 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006688 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006689 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006690
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006691 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6692 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6693
6694 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6695 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6696 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6697
6698 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6699 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006700
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006701 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6702 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6703 # at offset 44.
6704
6705 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6706 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6707
6708 # Learn on response if server hello.
6709 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006710
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006711 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6712 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6713
6714 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6715 extraction.
6716
6717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006718tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6719 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6721 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006722 Arguments :
6723 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006724 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6725 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006726
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006727 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006728
6729 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6730 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006731 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6732 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6733 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6734 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6735 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6736 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006737
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006738 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6739 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6740 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6741 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006742
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006743 Three types of actions are supported :
6744 - accept :
6745 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6746 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6747 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006748
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006749 - reject :
6750 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6751 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6752 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6753 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6754 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6755 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6756 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6757 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6758 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6759 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6760 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6761 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006762
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006763 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6764 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6765 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6766 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6767 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6768 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6769 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6770 hosts.
6771
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006772 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006773 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6774 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6775 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006776 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6777 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006778 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006779 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6780 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6781 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6782 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6783 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006784
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006785 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006786 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006787 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006788 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6789 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6790 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6791 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006792
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006793 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6794 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6795 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6796 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006797
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006798 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6799 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6800 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6801 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6802 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006803 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6804 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6805 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6806 layer7 information is extracted.
6807
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006808 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6809 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6810 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6811 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6812 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006813
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006814 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6815 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6816 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006817
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006818 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6819 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6820 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006821
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006822 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006823 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006824 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006826 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6827 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6828 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006830 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006831 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6832 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006833
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006834 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6835
6836 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6837
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006838 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006840 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006841
6842
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006843tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6844 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006846 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006847 Arguments :
6848 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006849 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6850 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006851 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006852
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006853 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006855 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6856 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6857 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6858 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6859 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006861 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6862 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6863 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6864 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6865 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6866 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6867 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6868 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6869 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006870
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006871 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6872 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6873 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6874 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006876 Three types of actions are supported :
6877 - accept :
6878 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006879 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006880
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006881 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6882 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006883
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006884 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6885 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6886 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006887 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6888 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6889 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6890 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006891 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6892 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006893 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006895 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006896 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6897 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006899 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006900 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6901 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6902 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6903 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6904 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006905
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006906 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6907 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6908 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6909 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6910
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006911 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006912 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6913 # and reject everything else.
6914 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6915 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006916 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006917 tcp-request content reject
6918
6919 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006920 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6921 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6922 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006923 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006924
6925 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6926 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6927 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006928 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006929 tcp-request content reject
6930
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006931 Example:
6932 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6933 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006934 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006935
6936 Example:
6937 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6938 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006939 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006940
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006941 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6942 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6943
6944 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006945 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006946 # protecting all our sites
6947 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006948 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6949 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006950 ...
6951 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6952
6953 backend http_dynamic
6954 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006955 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006956 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006957 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6958 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6959 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006960 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006962 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006964 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006965
6966
6967tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6968 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006970 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006971 Arguments :
6972 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6973 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6974 as explained at the top of this document.
6975
6976 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6977 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6978 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6979 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6980 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6981
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006982 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6983 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6984 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6985 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6986
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006987 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6988 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006989 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006990 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006991 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6992 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6993 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6994 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006995
6996 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6997 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6998 it pass through unaffected.
6999
7000 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7001 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7002 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007003 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007004 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7005 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007006 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7007 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7008 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007009
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007010 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007011 "timeout client".
7012
7013
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007014tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7015 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 no | no | yes | yes
7018 Arguments :
7019 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007020 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007021
7022 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7023
7024 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7025 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7026 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007027 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7028 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007029
7030 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7031
7032 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7033 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7034 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7035 inserted.
7036
7037 Two types of actions are supported :
7038 - accept :
7039 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7040 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7041 the rules evaluation.
7042
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007043 - close :
7044 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7045 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7046 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7047 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7048 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7049 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7050 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7051 protocols.
7052
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007053 - reject :
7054 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7055 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007056 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007057
7058 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7059 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7060 for changing the default action to a reject.
7061
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007062 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7063 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7064 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7065 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007066 period.
7067
7068 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7069
7070 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7071
7072
7073tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7074 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 no | no | yes | yes
7077 Arguments :
7078 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7079 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7080 as explained at the top of this document.
7081
7082 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7083
7084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007085timeout check <timeout>
7086 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7087 established.
7088
7089 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 yes | no | yes | yes
7091 Arguments:
7092 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7094 as explained at the top of this document.
7095
7096 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7097 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7098 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7099 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007100 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7101 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7102 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007103
7104 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7105 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7106
7107 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7108 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007109 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007110
7111 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7112 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7113 forget about it.
7114
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007115 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7116 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007117
7118
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007119timeout client <timeout>
7120timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7121 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | yes | yes | no
7124 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007125 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007126 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7127 as explained at the top of this document.
7128
7129 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7130 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7131 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7132 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7133 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7134 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7135 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7136 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007137 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007138 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007139 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7140 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7141 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007142
7143 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7144 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7145 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7146 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7147 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7148 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7149
7150 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7151 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7152 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7153
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007154 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007155
7156
7157timeout connect <timeout>
7158timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7159 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7161 yes | no | yes | yes
7162 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007163 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007164 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7165 as explained at the top of this document.
7166
7167 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007168 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007169 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007170 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007171 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7172 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007173
7174 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7175 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7176 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7177 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7178 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7179 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7180
7181 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7182 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7183 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7184
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007185 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7186 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007187
7188
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007189timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7190 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7192 yes | yes | yes | yes
7193 Arguments :
7194 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7195 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7196 as explained at the top of this document.
7197
7198 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7199 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7200 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7201 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7202 once the request has started to present itself.
7203
7204 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7205 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7206 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7207 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7208 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7209
7210 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7211 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7212 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7213 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7214
7215 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7216 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7217 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7218 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7219 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007220 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007221
7222 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7223 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7224 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7225 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7226
7227 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7228
7229
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007230timeout http-request <timeout>
7231 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007233 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007234 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007235 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007236 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7237 as explained at the top of this document.
7238
7239 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7240 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7241 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7242 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7243 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7244 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7245 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7246 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7247
7248 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7249 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007250 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7251 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007252
7253 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7254 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7255 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7256 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7257 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7258
7259 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007260 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7261 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7262 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007263
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007264 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007265
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007266
7267timeout queue <timeout>
7268 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | no | yes | yes
7271 Arguments :
7272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7274 as explained at the top of this document.
7275
7276 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7277 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7278 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7279 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7280 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7281
7282 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7283 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7284 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7285 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7286
7287 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7288
7289
7290timeout server <timeout>
7291timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7292 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | no | yes | yes
7295 Arguments :
7296 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7297 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7298 as explained at the top of this document.
7299
7300 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7301 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7302 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7303 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7304 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7305 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7306 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7307
7308 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7309 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7310 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7311 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7312 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007313 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007314 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007315 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7316 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7317 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7318 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007319
7320 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7321 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7322 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7323 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7324 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7325 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7326
7327 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7328 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7329 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7330
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007331 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007332
7333
7334timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007335 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | yes | yes | yes
7338 Arguments :
7339 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7341 as explained at the top of this document.
7342
7343 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7344 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7345 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7346
7347 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7348 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7349 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7350 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007351 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007352
7353 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7354
7355
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007356timeout tunnel <timeout>
7357 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 yes | no | yes | yes
7360 Arguments :
7361 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7362 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7363 as explained at the top of this document.
7364
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007365 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007366 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7367 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7368 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7369 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7370 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7371 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7372 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7373 specified.
7374
7375 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7376 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7377 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7378 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7379 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7380
7381 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7382 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7383 forget about it.
7384
7385 Example :
7386 defaults http
7387 option http-server-close
7388 timeout connect 5s
7389 timeout client 30s
7390 timeout client 30s
7391 timeout server 30s
7392 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7393
7394 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7395
7396
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007397transparent (deprecated)
7398 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007400 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007401 Arguments : none
7402
7403 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7404 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7405 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7406 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7407 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7408 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7409 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7410 appropriate server.
7411
7412 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7413
7414 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7415 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7416
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007417 See also: "option transparent"
7418
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007419unique-id-format <string>
7420 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7422 yes | yes | yes | no
7423 Arguments :
7424 <string> is a log-format string.
7425
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007426 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7427 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7428 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7429 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007430
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007431 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7432 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7433 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7434 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7435 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7436 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7437 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7438 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007439
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007440 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7441 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007442
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007443 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007444
7445 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7446
7447 will generate:
7448
7449 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7450
7451 See also: "unique-id-header"
7452
7453unique-id-header <name>
7454 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 yes | yes | yes | no
7457 Arguments :
7458 <name> is the name of the header.
7459
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007460 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7461 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007462
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007463 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007464
7465 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7466 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7467
7468 will generate:
7469
7470 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7471
7472 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007473
7474use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7475use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007476 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7478 no | yes | yes | no
7479 Arguments :
7480 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007482 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007483
7484 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7485 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7486 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007487 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7488 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7489 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7490 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007491
7492 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7493 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7494 assign the backend.
7495
7496 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7497 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7498 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7499 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7500 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7501 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7502
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007503 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007504 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007505 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7506 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7507 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7508
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007509 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007510
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007511
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007512use-server <server> if <condition>
7513use-server <server> unless <condition>
7514 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7516 no | no | yes | yes
7517 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007518 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007519
7520 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7521
7522 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7523 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7524 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7525
7526 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7527 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7528 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7529 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7530 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7531 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7532 matches will assign the server.
7533
7534 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7535 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7536 with the next rules until one matches.
7537
7538 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7539 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7540 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7541 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7542
7543 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7544 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7545 stripped.
7546
7547 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7548 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7549 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7550 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7551
7552 Example :
7553 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7554 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7555 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7556 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7557 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7558 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7559 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7560 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7561 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7562
7563 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7564
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007565
75665. Bind and Server options
7567--------------------------
7568
7569The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7570depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7571settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7572written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7573described in this section.
7574
7575
75765.1. Bind options
7577-----------------
7578
7579The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7580as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7581no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7582parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7583while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7584provided immediately after the setting name.
7585
7586The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7587
7588accept-proxy
7589 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7590 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7591 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7592 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7593 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7594 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7595 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7596 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7597 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007598 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7599 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007600
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007601alpn <protocols>
7602 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7603 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7604 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7605 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7606 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7607 initial NPN extension.
7608
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007609backlog <backlog>
7610 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7611 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7612
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007613ecdhe <named curve>
7614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007615 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7616 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007617
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007618ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7620 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7621 client's certificate.
7622
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007623ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7625 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7626 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7627 error is ignored.
7628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007629ciphers <ciphers>
7630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7631 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7632 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7633 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7634 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7635
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007636crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7638 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7639 to verify client's certificate.
7640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007641crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7643 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7644 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7645 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7646 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7647 file.
7648
7649 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7650 are loaded.
7651
7652 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7653 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7654 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7655 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7656 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7657 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7658 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7659 www.sub.example.org).
7660
7661 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7662 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7663 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7664 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7665 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7666
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007667 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007668
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007669 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7670 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7671 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7672 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7673 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7674 clients).
7675
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007676crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7678 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7679 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7680 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007681
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007682crt-list <file>
7683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007684 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7685 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007686
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007687 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007688
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007689 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7690 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7691 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7692 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7693 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7694 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7695 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7696 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007697
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007698defer-accept
7699 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7700 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7701 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7702 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7703 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7704 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7705 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7706 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7707 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7708 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7709 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7710
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007711force-sslv3
7712 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7713 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7714 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7715
7716force-tlsv10
7717 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7718 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7719
7720force-tlsv11
7721 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7722 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7723
7724force-tlsv12
7725 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7726 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007728gid <gid>
7729 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7730 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7731 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7732 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7733 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7734
7735group <group>
7736 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7737 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7738 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7739 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7740 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7741
7742id <id>
7743 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7744 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7745 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7746 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7747
7748interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007749 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7750 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7751 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7752 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7753 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7754 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7755 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007756
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007757level <level>
7758 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7759 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7760 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7761 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7762 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7763 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7764 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7765 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7766 counters).
7767 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7768 all counters).
7769
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007770maxconn <maxconn>
7771 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7772 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7773 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7774 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7775 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7776 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7777 eat all memory.
7778
7779mode <mode>
7780 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7781 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7782 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7783 UNIX sockets.
7784
7785mss <maxseg>
7786 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7787 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7788 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7789 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7790 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7791 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7792 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7793 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7794 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7795 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7796 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7797
7798name <name>
7799 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7800 page.
7801
7802nice <nice>
7803 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7804 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7805 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7806 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7807 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7808 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7809 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7810 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7811 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7812 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7813 one for an RDP socket.
7814
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007815no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7817 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7818 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007819 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7820 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007821
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007822no-tls-tickets
7823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7824 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7825 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7826 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7827
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007828no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007830 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7831 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7832 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7833 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007834
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007835no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007837 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7838 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7839 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7840 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007841
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007842no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007844 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7845 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7846 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7847 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007848
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007849npn <protocols>
7850 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7851 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7852 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7853 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007854 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7855 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007857ssl
7858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7859 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7860 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7861 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7862 to deciphered contents.
7863
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007864strict-sni
7865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7866 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7867 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7868 See the "crt" option for more information.
7869
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007870tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007871 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007872 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7873 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7874 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7875 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7876 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7877 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7878 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007879 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7880 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7881 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007882
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007883transparent
7884 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7885 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7886 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7887 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7888 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7889 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7890 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7891 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7892 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7893 so check for support with your vendor.
7894
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007895v4v6
7896 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7897 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7898 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7899 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7900 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7901
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007902v6only
7903 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7904 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7905 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007906 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7907 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007908
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007909uid <uid>
7910 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7911 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7912 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7913 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7914 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7915
7916user <user>
7917 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7918 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7919 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7920 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7921 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7922
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007923verify [none|optional|required]
7924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7925 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7926 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7927 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7928 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007929 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7930 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7931 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7932 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020079345.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007935------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007937The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7938which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7939arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7940settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7941after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7942Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7943address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007945 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007946 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007948The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007949
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007950addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007951 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7952 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7953 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7954 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7955 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007957 Supported in default-server: No
7958
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007959agent-check
7960 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
7961 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
7962 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
7963 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
7964
7965 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
7966 e.g. "75%"
7967
7968 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
7969 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
7970
7971 * The string "drain".
7972
7973 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
7974 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
7975 persistence.
7976
7977 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
7978
7979 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
7980
7981 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
7982
7983 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
7984
7985 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
7986
7987 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
7988
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09007989 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
7990 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
7991 parameter.
7992
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007993 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
7994 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
7995
7996 Supported in default-server: No
7997
7998agent-inter <delay>
7999 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8000 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8001
8002 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8003 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8004 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8005 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8006 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8007 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8008 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8009 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8010 of backends use the same servers.
8011
8012 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8013
8014 Supported in default-server: Yes
8015
8016agent-port <port>
8017 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8018
8019 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8020
8021 Supported in default-server: Yes
8022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008023backup
8024 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8025 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8026 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8027 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8028 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8029 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008031 Supported in default-server: No
8032
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008033ca-file <cafile>
8034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8035 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8036 server's certificate.
8037
8038 Supported in default-server: No
8039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008040check
8041 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008042 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8043 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8044 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8045 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8046 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8047 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8048 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008049 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8050 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8051 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008053 Supported in default-server: No
8054
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008055check-send-proxy
8056 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8057 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8058 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8059 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8060 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8061 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8062 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8063
8064 Supported in default-server: No
8065
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008066check-ssl
8067 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8068 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8069 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8070 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8071 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8072 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8073 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8074 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8075 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8076
8077 Supported in default-server: No
8078
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008079ciphers <ciphers>
8080 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8081 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8082 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8083 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8084 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8085 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8086 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8087 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8088
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008089 Supported in default-server: No
8090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008091cookie <value>
8092 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8093 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8094 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8095 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8096 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8097 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8098 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008100 Supported in default-server: No
8101
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008102crl-file <crlfile>
8103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8104 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8105 to verify server's certificate.
8106
8107 Supported in default-server: No
8108
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008109crt <cert>
8110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8111 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8112 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8113 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8114 certificate request.
8115
8116 Supported in default-server: No
8117
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008118disabled
8119 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8120 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8121 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8122 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8123 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8124
8125 Supported in default-server: No
8126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008127error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008128 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8129 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8130 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008132 Supported in default-server: Yes
8133
8134 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008136fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008137 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8138 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8139 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008141 Supported in default-server: Yes
8142
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008143force-sslv3
8144 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8145 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8146 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8147
8148 Supported in default-server: No
8149
8150force-tlsv10
8151 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8152 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8153
8154 Supported in default-server: No
8155
8156force-tlsv11
8157 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8158 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8159
8160 Supported in default-server: No
8161
8162force-tlsv12
8163 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8164 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8165
8166 Supported in default-server: No
8167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008168id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008169 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8170 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8171 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008173 Supported in default-server: No
8174
8175inter <delay>
8176fastinter <delay>
8177downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008178 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8179 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8180 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8181 between checks depending on the server state :
8182
8183 Server state | Interval used
8184 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8185 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8186 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8187 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8188 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8189 or yet unchecked. |
8190 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8191 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8192 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008194 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8195 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8196 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8197 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008198 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8199 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8200 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8201 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8202 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008204 Supported in default-server: Yes
8205
8206maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008207 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8208 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8209 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8210 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8211 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8212 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8213 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8214 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008216 Supported in default-server: Yes
8217
8218maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008219 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8220 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8221 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8222 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8223 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8224 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8225 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008227 Supported in default-server: Yes
8228
8229minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008230 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8231 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8232 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8233 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8234 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8235 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008236 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008237 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008239 Supported in default-server: Yes
8240
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008241no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008242 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8243 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008244 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008245
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008246 Supported in default-server: No
8247
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008248no-tls-tickets
8249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8250 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8251 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8252 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8253
8254 Supported in default-server: No
8255
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008256no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008257 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008258 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8259 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008260 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8261 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008262
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008263 Supported in default-server: No
8264
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008265no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008266 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008267 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8268 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008269 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8270 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008271
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008272 Supported in default-server: No
8273
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008274no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008275 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008276 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8277 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008278 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8279 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008280
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008281 Supported in default-server: No
8282
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008283non-stick
8284 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8285 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8286 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8287
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008288 Supported in default-server: No
8289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008290observe <mode>
8291 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8292 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8293 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8294 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8295 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8296 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008297 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008299 Supported in default-server: No
8300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008301 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008303on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008304 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8305 Currently, four modes are available:
8306 - fastinter: force fastinter
8307 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8308 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8309 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8310 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008312 Supported in default-server: Yes
8313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008314 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8315
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008316on-marked-down <action>
8317 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8318 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008319 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8320 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8321 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8322 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8323 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8324 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8325 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8326 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008327
8328 Actions are disabled by default
8329
8330 Supported in default-server: Yes
8331
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008332on-marked-up <action>
8333 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8334 Currently one action is available:
8335 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8336 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8337 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8338 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8339 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8340 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8341 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8342 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8343
8344 Actions are disabled by default
8345
8346 Supported in default-server: Yes
8347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008348port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008349 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8350 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8351 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8352 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8353 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8354 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008356 Supported in default-server: Yes
8357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008358redir <prefix>
8359 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8360 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8361 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8362 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8363 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8364 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8365 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8366 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008367 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008368 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8369 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8370 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8371 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8372 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8373
8374 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008376 Supported in default-server: No
8377
8378rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008379 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8380 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8381 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008383 Supported in default-server: Yes
8384
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008385send-proxy
8386 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8387 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8388 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8389 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8390 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8391 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8392 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8393 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8394 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008395 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8396 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8397 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8398 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8399 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008400
8401 Supported in default-server: No
8402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008403slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008404 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8405 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8406 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8407 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8408 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8409 parameters :
8410
8411 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8412 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8413
8414 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8415 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8416 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8417 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8418
8419 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8420 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8421 seen as failed.
8422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008423 Supported in default-server: Yes
8424
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008425source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008426source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008427source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008428 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8429 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8430 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8431 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8432
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008433 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8434 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8435 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8436 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8437 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8438 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8439 server.
8440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008441 Supported in default-server: No
8442
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008443ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008444 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8445 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8446 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8447 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8448 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8449 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8450 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008451
8452 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008454track [<proxy>/]<server>
8455 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8456 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8457 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8458 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8459 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008461 Supported in default-server: No
8462
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008463verify [none|required]
8464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8465 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8466 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8467 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008468 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8469 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8470 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008471
8472 Supported in default-server: No
8473
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008474verifyhost <hostname>
8475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8476 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8477 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8478 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8479 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8480 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8481
8482 Supported in default-server: No
8483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008484weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008485 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8486 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8487 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008488 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8489 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8490 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8491 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8492 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8493 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008495 Supported in default-server: Yes
8496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008497
84986. HTTP header manipulation
8499---------------------------
8500
8501In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8502response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8503request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8504which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8505against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8506to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8507passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8508headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8509never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8510
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008511There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8512(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8513rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8514messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8515in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008516happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008517add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8518normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008520This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8521in section 4.2 :
8522
8523 - reqadd <string>
8524 - reqallow <search>
8525 - reqiallow <search>
8526 - reqdel <search>
8527 - reqidel <search>
8528 - reqdeny <search>
8529 - reqideny <search>
8530 - reqpass <search>
8531 - reqipass <search>
8532 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8533 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8534 - reqtarpit <search>
8535 - reqitarpit <search>
8536 - rspadd <string>
8537 - rspdel <search>
8538 - rspidel <search>
8539 - rspdeny <search>
8540 - rspideny <search>
8541 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8542 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8543
8544With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8545is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8546parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8547prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8548Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8549
8550 \t for a tab
8551 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8552 \n for a new line (LF)
8553 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8554 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8555 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8556 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8557 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8558
8559The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8560portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8561above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8562regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
85639 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8564is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8565
8566The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8567after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8568
8569Notes related to these keywords :
8570---------------------------------
8571 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8572 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8573 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8574
8575 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8576 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8577 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8578
8579 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8580 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8581 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8582 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8583 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8584
8585 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8586 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8587 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8588 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8589 useless headers before adding new ones.
8590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008591 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008592 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8593
8594 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8595 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8596 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8597
8598 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8599 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008600 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008601
8602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086037. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8604----------------------------------
8605
8606Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8607client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8608The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8609these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8610but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8611data called patterns.
8612
8613
86147.1. ACL basics
8615---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008616
8617The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8618content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8619from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8620simple :
8621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008622 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008623 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008624 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8625 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008627The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8628adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008629
8630In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008632 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008633
8634This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8635Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8636and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008637an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8638conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8639as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8640are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008641
8642ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8643'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8644which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8645
8646There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8647performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008649The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8650specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8651this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008652methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8653ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008654
8655Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8656 - boolean
8657 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8658 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8659 - string
8660 - data block
8661
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008662Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8663converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8664would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8665The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8666which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008668The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8669 - boolean
8670 - integer or integer range
8671 - IP address / network
8672 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8673 - regular expression
8674 - hex block
8675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008676The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8677
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008678 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8679 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008680 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008681 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008683The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8684read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8685if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8686lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8687will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8688beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8689a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8690lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8691exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8692
8693Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8694loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8695
8696 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8697
8698In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8699the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8700case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8701as well.
8702
8703The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8704sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8705do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8706methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8707is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8708obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8709followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8710default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8711that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8712string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8713
8714There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8715sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8716be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008717
8718 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8719 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008720 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8721 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8722 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8723 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008724
8725 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8726 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008727 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008728
8729 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008730 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008731
8732 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008733 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008734
8735 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8736 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8737
8738 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8739 binary or string samples.
8740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008741 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8742 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008744 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8745 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8746 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008748 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8749 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008751 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8752 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008754 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8755 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008757 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8758 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008759 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008761 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8762 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8763 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008764
8765For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8766request, it is possible to do :
8767
8768 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8769
8770In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8771buffer, one would use the following acl :
8772
8773 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8774
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008775On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8776possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8777
8778 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008780All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8781criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8782method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8783to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8784criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8785the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008787If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8788the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8789example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008791 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8792 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8793 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8794 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008795
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008796
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008797The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008798and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8799combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8800the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008802 +-------------------------------------------------+
8803 | Input sample type |
8804 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8805 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8806 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8807 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8808 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008809 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008810 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008811 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008812 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008813 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008814 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008815 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008816 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008817 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008818 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008819 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008820 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008821 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008822 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008823 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008824 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008825 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008826 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008827 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008828 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008829 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008830 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8831 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8832 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008833
8834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088357.1.1. Matching booleans
8836------------------------
8837
8838In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8839Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8840When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8841that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8842
8843Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8844return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8845"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088487.1.2. Matching integers
8849------------------------
8850
8851Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8852enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8853to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8854
8855Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8856matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8857lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008858
8859For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8860unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8861representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8862
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008863As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8864two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8865instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8866ranges and operators.
8867
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008868For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008869operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8870Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8871of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008872
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008873Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008874
8875 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8876 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8877 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8878 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8879 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008881For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008882
8883 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8884
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008885This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8886
8887 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088907.1.3. Matching strings
8891-----------------------
8892
8893String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8894different forms :
8895
8896 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8897 patterns ;
8898
8899 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8900 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8901
8902 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8903 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8904
8905 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8906 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8907
8908 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8909 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8910 matches.
8911
8912 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8913 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8914 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008915
8916String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8917exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8918characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8919string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8920to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008921before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008922
8923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089247.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8925---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008926
8927Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8928they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8929possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8930passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8931the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008932the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8933match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008934
8935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089367.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8937-------------------------------------
8938
8939It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8940not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8941a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8942to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8943digits may be used upper or lower case.
8944
8945Example :
8946 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8947 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8948
8949
89507.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8951---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008952
8953IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8954netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8955within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008956host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008957difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8958at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8959does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8960parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008961
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008962IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8963Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8964trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8965IPv6 patterns.
8966
8967HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8968following situations :
8969 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8970 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8971 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8972 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8973 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8974 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8975 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8976 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8977 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8978 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008980
89817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8982----------------------------------
8983
8984Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8985combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8986
8987 - AND (implicit)
8988 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8989 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008991A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008993 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008995Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8996indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008998For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8999"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9000requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9001is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9002
9003 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9004 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9005 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9006 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9007
9008To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9009and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9010
9011 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9012 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9013 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9014 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9015
9016 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9017 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9018 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9019 use_backend www if host_www
9020
9021It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9022expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9023be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9024the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9025
9026 The following rule :
9027
9028 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9029 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9030
9031 Can also be written that way :
9032
9033 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9034
9035It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9036to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9037simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9038sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9039good use is the following :
9040
9041 With named ACLs :
9042
9043 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9044 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9045 monitor fail if site_dead
9046
9047 With anonymous ACLs :
9048
9049 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9050
9051See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9052
9053
90547.3. Fetching samples
9055---------------------
9056
9057Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9058against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9059sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9060ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9061of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9062available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9063
9064This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9065Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9066compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9067deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9068
9069The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9070matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9071method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9072indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9073
9074As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9075when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9076mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9077the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9078ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9079
9080Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9081multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9082when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9083incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9084are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9085is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9086all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9087
9088Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9089 - name
9090 - name(arg1)
9091 - name(arg1,arg2)
9092
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009093Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9094of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9095is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9096was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9097has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9098unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9099
9100These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9101sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9102the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9103support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009105The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009107 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9108 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9109 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009111 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9112 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9113 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009115 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9116 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9117 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9118 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9119 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9120
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009121 http_date([<offset>])
9122 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9123 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9124 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9125 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9126 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9127 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9128 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9129 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009130
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009131 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9132 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9133 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9134 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9135 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9136 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9137 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9138 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9139 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9140 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9141 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9142 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9143 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9144 the map* converters.
9145
9146 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9147 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9148 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9149 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9150
9151 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9152 | `-_ out | | | |
9153 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9154 | / match `-_ | | | |
9155 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9156 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9157 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9158 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9159 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9160 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9161 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9162 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9163 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9164 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9165
9166 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9167 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9168 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9169 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9170 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9171 trailing spaces/tabs.
9172
9173 Example :
9174
9175 # this is a comment and is ignored
9176 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9177 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9178 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9179 | | | `----------- value
9180 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9181 | `---------------------------- key
9182 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091847.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9185--------------------------------------------
9186
9187A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9188not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9189"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9190The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9191
9192always_false : boolean
9193 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9194 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9195
9196always_true : boolean
9197 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9198 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9199
9200avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009201 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009202 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9203 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9204 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9205 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9206 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9207 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9208 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9209 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9210 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9211 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9212 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9213 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9214 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009216be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009217 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9218 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9219 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9220 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9221 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009223be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9225 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9226 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9227 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9228 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9229 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009230
9231 Example :
9232 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9233 backend dynamic
9234 mode http
9235 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9236 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009238connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9239 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9240 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9241 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9242 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009243
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009244 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009245 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009246 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9247
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009248 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9249 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009250
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009251 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009252 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009253 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009254 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9255 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009256 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009257 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009258
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009259 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9260 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009261 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009262 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009263
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009264date([<offset>]) : integer
9265 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9266 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9267 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9268 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009269 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9270
9271 Example :
9272
9273 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9274 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009275
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009276env(<name>) : string
9277 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9278 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9279 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9280 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9281 certain way.
9282
9283 Examples :
9284 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9285 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9286
9287 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9288 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009290fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9291 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009292 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9293 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009294 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9295 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9296 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9297 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9298 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009300fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9301 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9302 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9303 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9304 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9305 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9306 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9307 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9308 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009309
9310 Example :
9311 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9312 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9313 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9314 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9315 frontend mail
9316 bind :25
9317 mode tcp
9318 maxconn 100
9319 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9320 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9321 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9322 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009324nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9326 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9327 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009328 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9329 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9330 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009332queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009333 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9334 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9335 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009336 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9337 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9338 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9339 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9340 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9341
9342srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9344 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9345 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9346 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9347 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9348 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9349 methods.
9350
9351srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9352 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9353 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9354 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9355 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9356 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9357 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9358 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9359
9360srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9361 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9362 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9363 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9364 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9365 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9366 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9367 overloading servers).
9368
9369 Example :
9370 # Redirect to a separate back
9371 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9372 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9373 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9374
9375table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9376 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9377 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9378
9379table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9380 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9381 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9382 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9383
9384
93857.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9386----------------------------------
9387
9388The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9389closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9390methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9391sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9392TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009393the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9394counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9395"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009396argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9397the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9398this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009399
9400be_id : integer
9401 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9402 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9403
9404dst : ip
9405 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9406 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9407 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9408 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9409 RFC 4291.
9410
9411dst_conn : integer
9412 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9413 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9414 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9415 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9416 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9417 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9418 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9419 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009421dst_port : integer
9422 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9423 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9424 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9425 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9426 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9427 an HTTP header.
9428
9429fe_id : integer
9430 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9431 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9432 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9433
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009434sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9435sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9436sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9437sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009438 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9439 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9440 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9441
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009442sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9443sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9444sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9445sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009446 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9447 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9448 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9449
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009450sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9451sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9452sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9453sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009454 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9455 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009456 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9457 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9458 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009459
9460 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9461 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009462 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9463 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9464 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009465 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9466 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9467
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009468sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9469sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9470sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9471sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009472 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9473 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9474
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009475sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9476sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9477sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9478sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009479 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9480 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9481 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9482
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009483sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9484sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9485sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9486sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9488 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9489 See also src_conn_rate.
9490
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009491sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9492sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9493sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9494sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009495 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009496 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009497
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009498sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9499sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9500sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9501sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009502 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9503 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9504 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009505 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9506 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9507 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009508
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009509sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9510sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9511sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9512sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009513 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9514 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9515 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9516
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009517sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9518sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9519sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9520sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009521 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9522 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9523 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9524 src_http_err_rate.
9525
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009526sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9527sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9528sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9529sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009530 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9531 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9532 src_http_req_cnt.
9533
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009534sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9535sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9536sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9537sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009538 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9539 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9540 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9541 src_http_req_rate.
9542
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009543sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9544sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9545sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9546sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009547 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009548 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9549 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9550 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9551 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009552
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009553 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9554 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009555 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9556
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009557sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9558sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9559sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9560sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009561 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9562 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9563 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9564 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9565
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009566sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9567sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9568sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9569sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009570 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9571 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9572 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9573 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9574
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009575sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9576sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9577sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9578sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009579 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9580 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9581 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9582 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009583 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9585
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009586sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9587sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9588sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9589sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009590 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9591 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9592 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9593 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9594 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009595 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009596
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009597sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9598sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9599sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9600sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009601 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9602 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9603 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9604
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009605sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9606sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9607sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9608sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009609 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9610 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009611 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009612 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9613 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009614 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9615 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9616 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618so_id : integer
9619 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9620 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9621 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009623src : ip
9624 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9625 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9626 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9627 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9628 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9629 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9630 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009631
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009632 Example:
9633 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9634 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9637 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9638 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9639 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009640 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9643 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9644 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009645 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009646 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009648src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9649 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9650 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9651 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9652 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9653 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9654 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009655
9656 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9657 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9658 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9659 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009660 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009661 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9662 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009665 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009666 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009667 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009668 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009670src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009671 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009672 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9673 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009674 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009676src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9677 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9678 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9679 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009680 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009682src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009683 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009684 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009685 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009686 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009688src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009689 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009690 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009691 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9692 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009693 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9694 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9695 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009697src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9698 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9699 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009700 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009701 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009702 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9705 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9706 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9707 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9708 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009709 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009711src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9712 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9713 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9714 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009715 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009717src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9718 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9719 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9720 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009721 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009722 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009724src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9725 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9726 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9727 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009728 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009729 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9730 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009731
9732 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009733 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009734 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009736src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9737 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9738 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9739 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9740 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009741 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9742 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009744src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9745 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9746 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009747 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9748 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009749 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009751src_port : integer
9752 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9753 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9754 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9755 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009757src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9758 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009759 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9760 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9761 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009762 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009764src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9765 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9766 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9767 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9768 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009769 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009771src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9772 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9773 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9774 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9775 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9776 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9777 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9778 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9779 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009780
9781 Example :
9782 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9783 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9784 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9785 listen ssh
9786 bind :22
9787 mode tcp
9788 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009789 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009790 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009791 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009793srv_id : integer
9794 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9795 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9796 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009797
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097997.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9800----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009802The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9803closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9804when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9805usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9806future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9809 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9810 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9811 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9812 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9813 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009815ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9816 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9817 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9818 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9819 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009821ssl_c_err : integer
9822 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9823 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9824 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9825 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9826 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009828ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9829 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9830 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9831 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9832 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9833 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9834 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9835 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9836 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009838 ACL derivatives :
9839 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009841ssl_c_key_alg : string
9842 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9843 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9844 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009846 ACL derivatives :
9847 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009849ssl_c_notafter : string
9850 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9851 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9852 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009854 ACL derivatives :
9855 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009857ssl_c_notbefore : string
9858 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9859 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9860 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009862 ACL derivatives :
9863 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009865ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9866 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9867 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9868 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9869 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9870 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9871 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9872 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9873 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009875 ACL derivatives :
9876 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009878ssl_c_serial : binary
9879 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9880 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9881 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009883 ACL derivatives :
9884 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009886ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9887 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9888 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9889 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009891ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9892 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9893 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9894 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009896 ACL derivatives :
9897 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9898
9899ssl_c_used : boolean
9900 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9901 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009903ssl_c_verify : integer
9904 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9905 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9906 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9907 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009909ssl_c_version : integer
9910 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9911 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009913ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9914 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9915 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9916 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9917 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009918 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009919 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9920 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9921 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009923 ACL derivatives :
9924 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926ssl_f_key_alg : string
9927 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9928 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9929 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009931 ACL derivatives :
9932 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009934ssl_f_notafter : string
9935 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9936 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9937 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939 ACL derivatives :
9940 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009942ssl_f_notbefore : string
9943 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9944 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9945 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947 ACL derivatives :
9948 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009950ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9951 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9952 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9953 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9954 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9955 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9956 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9957 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9958 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009960 ACL derivatives :
9961 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009963ssl_f_serial : binary
9964 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9965 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9966 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009968 ACL derivatives :
9969 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009971ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9972 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9973 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9974 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976 ACL derivatives :
9977 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979ssl_f_version : integer
9980 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9981 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9982
9983ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009984 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9985 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9986 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009988 Example :
9989 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9990 listen http-https
9991 bind :80
9992 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9993 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9994
9995ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9996 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9997 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9998
9999ssl_fc_alpn : string
10000 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10001 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10002 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10003 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10004 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10005 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10006 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10007 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10008 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10009
10010 ACL derivatives :
10011 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013ssl_fc_cipher : string
10014 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10015 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010017 ACL derivatives :
10018 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010020ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010021 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10022 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010023 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10024 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10025 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10026 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10029 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010030 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10031 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10032 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10033 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010035ssl_fc_npn : string
10036 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10037 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10038 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10039 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10040 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10041 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10042 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10043 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010045 ACL derivatives :
10046 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010048ssl_fc_protocol : string
10049 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10050 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010052 ACL derivatives :
10053 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10054
10055ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10056 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10057 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10058 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10059 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010061ssl_fc_sni : string
10062 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10063 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10064 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10065 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10066 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10067
10068 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10069 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10070 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010071 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10072 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010074 ACL derivatives :
10075 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10076 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10077 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010079ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10080 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10081 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010082
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100847.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10085------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010087Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10088sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10089only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10090For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10091be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10092can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10093sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10094for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10095content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010097payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10098 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10099 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10100 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010102payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10103 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10104 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10105 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010107req.len : integer
10108req_len : integer (deprecated)
10109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10110 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10111 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10112 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10113 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10114 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10115 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10116 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10119 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010120 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10121 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10122 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10123 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010125 ACL alternatives :
10126 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010128req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10129 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10130 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10131 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10132 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010134 ACL alternatives :
10135 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010137 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010139req.proto_http : boolean
10140req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10141 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10142 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10143 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10144 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10145 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10146 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10147 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010149 Example:
10150 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10151 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10152 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010153 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10156rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10157 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10158 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10159 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10160 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10161 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10162 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10163 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10166 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10167 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10168 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10169 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10170 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172 ACL derivatives :
10173 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010175 Example :
10176 listen tse-farm
10177 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10178 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10179 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10180 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10181 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10182 persist rdp-cookie
10183 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10184 # This is only useful makes sense if
10185 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10186 stick-table type string size 204800
10187 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10188 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10189 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010191 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10192 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10195rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10196 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10197 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10198 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10199 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201 ACL derivatives :
10202 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010204req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10205req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10206 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10207 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10208 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10209 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10210 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10211 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10212 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214req.ssl_sni : string
10215req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10216 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10217 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10218 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10219 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10220 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10221 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10222 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10223 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10224 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10225 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10226 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10227 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229 ACL derivatives :
10230 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010232 Examples :
10233 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10234 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10235 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10236 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10237 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010239res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10240rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10241 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10242 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10243 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10244 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10245 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10246 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10247 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010249req.ssl_ver : integer
10250req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10251 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10252 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10253 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10254 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10255 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10256 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10257 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10258 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10259 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261 ACL derivatives :
10262 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010263
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010264res.len : integer
10265 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10266 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10267 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10268 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10269 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10270 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10271 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10272 content inspection.
10273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010274res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10275 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010276 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10277 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10278 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10279 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10282 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10283 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10284 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10285 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010287 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010289wait_end : boolean
10290 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10291 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10292 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10293 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10294 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10295 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10296 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10297 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299 Examples :
10300 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10301 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10302 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10305 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10306 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10307 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10308 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10309 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10310 tcp-request content reject
10311
10312
103137.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10314--------------------------------------
10315
10316It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10317This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10318data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10319its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10320HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10321content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10322to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10323more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10324response are indexed.
10325
10326base : string
10327 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10328 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10329 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10330 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10331 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10332 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10333 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10334 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10335
10336 ACL derivatives :
10337 base : exact string match
10338 base_beg : prefix match
10339 base_dir : subdir match
10340 base_dom : domain match
10341 base_end : suffix match
10342 base_len : length match
10343 base_reg : regex match
10344 base_sub : substring match
10345
10346base32 : integer
10347 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10348 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10349 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10350 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10351
10352base32+src : binary
10353 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10354 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10355 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10356 per-URL counters.
10357
10358req.cook([<name>]) : string
10359cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10360 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10361 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10362 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10363 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10364 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10365 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10366 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10367 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10368
10369 ACL derivatives :
10370 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10371 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10372 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10373 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10374 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10375 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10376 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10377 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10380cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10381 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10382 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010384req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10385cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10386 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10387 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10388 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10389 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010391cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10392 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10393 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10394 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10395 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10396 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10397 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10398 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10399 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10400 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10401 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10404 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10405 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10406 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10407 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10408 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010410req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10411 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10412 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10413 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10414 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10415 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10416 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10417 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10418 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010420req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10421 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10422 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10423 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10424 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010426req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10427 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10428 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10429 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10430 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10431 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10432 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10433 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10434 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10435 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10436 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10437 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010439 ACL derivatives :
10440 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10441 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10442 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10443 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10444 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10445 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10446 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10447 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10448
10449req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10450hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10451 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10452 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10453 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10454 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10455 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10456 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10457 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10458 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10459 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10460
10461req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10462hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10463 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10464 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10465 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10466 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10467 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10468 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10469 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10470 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10471
10472req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10473hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10474 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10475 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10476 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10477 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10478 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10479 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10480 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10481
10482http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10483 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10484 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10485 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10486 basic auth is supported.
10487
10488http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10489 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10490 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10491 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10492 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10493 basic auth is supported.
10494
10495 ACL derivatives :
10496 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10497
10498http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010499 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10500 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010501 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10502 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504method : integer + string
10505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10506 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10507 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10508 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10509 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10510 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10511 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513 ACL derivatives :
10514 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010516 Example :
10517 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10518 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10519 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521path : string
10522 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10523 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10524 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10525 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10526 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10527 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10528 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010530 ACL derivatives :
10531 path : exact string match
10532 path_beg : prefix match
10533 path_dir : subdir match
10534 path_dom : domain match
10535 path_end : suffix match
10536 path_len : length match
10537 path_reg : regex match
10538 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010540req.ver : string
10541req_ver : string (deprecated)
10542 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10543 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10544 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010546 ACL derivatives :
10547 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010549res.comp : boolean
10550 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10551 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10552 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554res.comp_algo : string
10555 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10556 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10557 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010559res.cook([<name>]) : string
10560scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10561 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10562 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10563 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565 ACL derivatives :
10566 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010568res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10569scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10570 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10571 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10572 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10575scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10576 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10577 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10578 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010580res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10581 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10582 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10583 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10584 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10585 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10586 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10587 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10588 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10589 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10592 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10593 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10594 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10595 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10596 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10599shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10600 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10601 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10602 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10603 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10604 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10605 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10606 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10607 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010609 ACL derivatives :
10610 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10611 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10612 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10613 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10614 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10615 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10616 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10617 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10618
10619res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10620shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10621 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10622 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10623 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10624 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10625 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10628shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10629 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10630 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10631 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10632 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10633 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10634 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010636res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10637shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10638 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10639 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10640 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10641 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10642 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10643 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010645res.ver : string
10646resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10647 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10648 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650 ACL derivatives :
10651 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010653set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10654 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10655 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10656 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10657 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010659 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10660 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010662 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010664status : integer
10665 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10666 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10667 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669url : string
10670 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10671 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10672 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10673 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10674 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10675 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10676 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678 ACL derivatives :
10679 url : exact string match
10680 url_beg : prefix match
10681 url_dir : subdir match
10682 url_dom : domain match
10683 url_end : suffix match
10684 url_len : length match
10685 url_reg : regex match
10686 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010688url_ip : ip
10689 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10690 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10691 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10692 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10693 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10694 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10695 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010697url_port : integer
10698 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10699 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10700 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10701 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010703urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10704url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10705 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10706 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10707 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10708 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10709 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10710 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10711 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10712 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10713 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715 ACL derivatives :
10716 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10717 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10718 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10719 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10720 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10721 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10722 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10723 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010724
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010726 Example :
10727 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10728 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10729 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10730 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10733 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10734 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10735 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010736
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107387.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010739---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010741Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10742every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010743order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010745ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10746---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010747FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010748HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010749HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10750HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010751HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10752HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10753HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10754HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10755LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010756METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10757METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10758METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10759METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10760METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10761METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010762RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010763REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010764TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010765WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10766---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010767
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107698. Logging
10770----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010771
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010772One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10773provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10774very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10775provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10776state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010777to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010778headers.
10779
10780In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10781about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10782send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10783
10784 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10785 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10786 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10787 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10788 at the termination.
10789
10790The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10791allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10792as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10793while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10794real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10795delay.
10796
10797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107988.1. Log levels
10799---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010800
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010801TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010802source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010803HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10804in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10805track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10806syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10807about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010808
10809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108108.2. Log formats
10811----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010812
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010813HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010814and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10815slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10816options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010817
10818 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10819 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10820 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10821 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10822 extents.
10823
10824 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10825 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10826 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10827 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10828 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10829
10830 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10831 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10832 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10833 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10834 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10835
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010836 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10837 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10838 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10839 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10840
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010841 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10842
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010843Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10844specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10845field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10846servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10847always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10848identifier.
10849
10850Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10851 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10852 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10853 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10854 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10855
10856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108578.2.1. Default log format
10858-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010859
10860This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10861as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10862format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10863
10864 Example :
10865 listen www
10866 mode http
10867 log global
10868 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10869
10870 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10871 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10872 (www/HTTP)
10873
10874 Field Format Extract from the example above
10875 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10876 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10877 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10878 4 'to' to
10879 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10880 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10881
10882Detailed fields description :
10883 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10884 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10885 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10886 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10887 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10888 and processed the connection.
10889 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10890
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010891In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10892"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10893connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10894
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010895It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10896will eventually disappear.
10897
10898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108998.2.2. TCP log format
10900---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010901
10902The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10903is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10904information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10905counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10906emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10907environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10908the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10909sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010910specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10911not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10912fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10913marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010914
10915 Example :
10916 frontend fnt
10917 mode tcp
10918 option tcplog
10919 log global
10920 default_backend bck
10921
10922 backend bck
10923 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10924
10925 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10926 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10927 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10928
10929 Field Format Extract from the example above
10930 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10931 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10932 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10933 4 frontend_name fnt
10934 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10935 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10936 7 bytes_read* 212
10937 8 termination_state --
10938 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10939 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10940
10941Detailed fields description :
10942 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010943 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10944 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10945 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10946 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10947 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010948
10949 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010950 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10951 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10952 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010953
10954 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10955 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10956 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10957 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10958
10959 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10960 and processed the connection.
10961
10962 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10963 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10964 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10965 applications.
10966
10967 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10968 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10969 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10970 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10971 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10972
10973 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10974 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10975 See "Timers" below for more details.
10976
10977 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10978 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10979 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10980 "Timers" below for more details.
10981
10982 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10983 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10984 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10985 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10986 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10987 details.
10988
10989 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10990 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10991 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10992 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10993 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10994
10995 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10996 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10997 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10998 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10999 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11000 for more details.
11001
11002 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011003 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011004 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11005 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11006 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011007 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011008
11009 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11010 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11011 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11012 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11013 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11014 caused by a denial of service attack.
11015
11016 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11017 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11018 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11019 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11020 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11021 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11022 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11023 denial of service attack.
11024
11025 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11026 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11027 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11028 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11029 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11030 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11031 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11032 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11033 be processed than on other servers.
11034
11035 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11036 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11037 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11038 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11039 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11040 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11041 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11042 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11043 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11044 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11045 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11046 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11047 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11048
11049 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11050 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11051 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11052 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11053 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11054 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11055 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11056 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11057
11058 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11059 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11060 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11061 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11062 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11063 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11064 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11065 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11066 occurs.
11067
11068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110698.2.3. HTTP log format
11070----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011071
11072The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11073is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11074the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11075are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11076emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11077generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11078"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11079which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011080frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11081is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011082
11083Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11084slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11085with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11086
11087 Example :
11088 frontend http-in
11089 mode http
11090 option httplog
11091 log global
11092 default_backend bck
11093
11094 backend static
11095 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11096
11097 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11098 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11099 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011100 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011101
11102 Field Format Extract from the example above
11103 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11104 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11105 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11106 4 frontend_name http-in
11107 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11108 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11109 7 status_code 200
11110 8 bytes_read* 2750
11111 9 captured_request_cookie -
11112 10 captured_response_cookie -
11113 11 termination_state ----
11114 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11115 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11116 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11117 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11118 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011119
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011120
11121Detailed fields description :
11122 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011123 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11124 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11125 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11126 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11127 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011128
11129 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011130 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11131 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11132 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011133
11134 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11135 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11136 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11137 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11138 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11139
11140 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11141 and processed the connection.
11142
11143 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11144 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11145 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11146
11147 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11148 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11149 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11150 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11151 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11152 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11153
11154 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11155 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11156 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11157 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11158 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11159 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11160
11161 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11162 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11163 See "Timers" below for more details.
11164
11165 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11166 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11167 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11168 below for more details.
11169
11170 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11171 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11172 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11173 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11174 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11175 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11176 for more details.
11177
11178 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11179 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11180 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11181 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11182 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11183 details.
11184
11185 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11186 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11187 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11188
11189 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11190 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11191 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11192 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11193 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11194 overflowing.
11195
11196 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11197 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11198 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11199 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11200 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11201 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11202 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11203 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11204
11205 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11206 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11207 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11208 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11209 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11210 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11211 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11212 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11213
11214 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11215 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11216 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11217 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11218 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11219 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11220 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11221
11222 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011223 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011224 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11225 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11226 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011227 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011228 system.
11229
11230 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11231 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11232 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11233 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11234 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11235 caused by a denial of service attack.
11236
11237 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11238 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11239 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11240 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11241 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11242 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11243 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11244 denial of service attack.
11245
11246 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11247 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11248 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11249 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11250 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11251 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11252 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11253 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11254 processed than on other servers.
11255
11256 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11257 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11258 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11259 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11260 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11261 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11262 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11263 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11264 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11265 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11266 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11267 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11268 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11269
11270 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11271 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11272 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11273 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11274 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11275 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11276 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11277 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11278
11279 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11280 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11281 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11282 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11283 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11284 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11285 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11286 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11287 occurs.
11288
11289 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11290 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11291 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11292 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11293 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11294 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11295 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11296 cookies" below for more details.
11297
11298 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11299 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11300 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11301 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11302 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11303 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11304 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11305 and cookies" below for more details.
11306
11307 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11308 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11309 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11310 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11311 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11312 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11313 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11314 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11315
11316
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200113178.2.4. Custom log format
11318------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011319
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011320The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011321mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011322
11323HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11324Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11325separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11326prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11327
11328Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11329variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11330string formats ("Q").
11331
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011332If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011333as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011334less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11335the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11336
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011337Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011338In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11339in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011340
11341Flags are :
11342 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011343 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011344
11345 Example:
11346
11347 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11348 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11349
11350At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11351
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011352 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11353 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011354
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011355the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011356
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011357 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011358 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011359 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011360
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011361and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11362
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011363 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011364 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11365
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011366Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11367
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011368 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011369 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011370 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11371 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11372 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011373 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11374 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11375 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011376 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011377 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011378 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011379 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011380 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011381 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011382 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11383 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011384 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011385 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11386 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011387 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011388 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11389 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011390 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11391 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11392 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011393 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011394 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11395 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011396 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011397 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11398 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11399 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011400 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011401 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11402 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11403 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11404 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011405 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011406 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011407 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011408 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011409 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011410 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011411 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11412 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11413 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011414 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011415 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11416 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011417 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011418 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011419 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011420 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011421
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011422 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011423
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011424
114258.2.5. Error log format
11426-----------------------
11427
11428When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11429protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11430By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11431"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11432will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11433logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11434
11435The format looks like this :
11436
11437 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11438 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11439 Connection error during SSL handshake
11440
11441 Field Format Extract from the example above
11442 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11443 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11444 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11445 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11446 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11447
11448These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11449failures.
11450
11451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114528.3. Advanced logging options
11453-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011454
11455Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11456just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11457options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11458for more information about their usage.
11459
11460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114618.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11462------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011463
11464It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11465haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11466commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11467monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11468ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11469
11470 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11471 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11472 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11473 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11474
11475 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11476 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11477 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11478 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11479 such as other load-balancers.
11480
11481 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11482 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11483 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11484
11485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114868.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11487----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011488
11489The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11490what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11491or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11492"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11493just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11494log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11495after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11496is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11497with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11498with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11499
11500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115018.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11502------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011503
11504Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11505for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11506"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11507retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11508raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11509a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11510file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11511you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11512"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11513
11514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115158.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11516--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011517
11518Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11519multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11520them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11521"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11522logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11523error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11524and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11525too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11526useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11527alternative.
11528
11529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115308.4. Timing events
11531------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011532
11533Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11534reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11535the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11536frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11537mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11538
11539 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11540 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11541 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11542 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11543 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11544
11545 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11546 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11547 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11548 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11549 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11550
11551 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11552 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11553 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11554 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11555 connection never established.
11556
11557 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11558 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11559 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11560 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11561 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11562 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11563 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11564 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11565 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11566 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11567 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11568
11569 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11570 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11571 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11572 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11573 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11574
11575 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11576
11577 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11578 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11579 negative.
11580
11581These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11582protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11583that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011584due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011585close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11586session has been aborted on timeout.
11587
11588Most common cases :
11589
11590 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11591 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11592 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11593 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11594 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11595 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11596 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11597 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11598 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011599 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11600 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11601 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011602
11603 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11604 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11605 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11606 of ms on remote networks.
11607
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011608 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11609 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11610 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011611
11612 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11613 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11614 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11615 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11616 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11617 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11618 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11619 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11620 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11621 to the server until another one is released.
11622
11623Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11624
11625 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11626 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11627 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11628
11629 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11630 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11631 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11632
11633 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11634 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11635 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11636 flags.
11637
11638 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11639 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11640 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11641 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11642 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11643 the client connection was maintained open.
11644
11645 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11646 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11647 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11648 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11649
11650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116518.5. Session state at disconnection
11652-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011653
11654TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11655"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
116562-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11657each of which has a special meaning :
11658
11659 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11660 session to terminate :
11661
11662 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11663
11664 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11665 server explicitly refused it.
11666
11667 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11668 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11669 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11670 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011671 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11672
11673 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11674 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011675
11676 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11677 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11678 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11679 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11680 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11681
11682 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11683 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11684 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11685 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11686 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11687
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011688 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11689 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11690
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011691 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11692 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11693 backup connections when going up.
11694
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011695 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011697 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11698 send or receive data.
11699
11700 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11701 send or receive data.
11702
11703 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11704 with nothing left in the buffers.
11705
11706 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11707
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011708 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011709 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11710
11711 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11712 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11713 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11714 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11715 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11716
11717 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11718 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11719
11720 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11721 server (HTTP only).
11722
11723 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11724
11725 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11726 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11727 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11728
11729 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11730 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11731 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11732
11733 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11734
11735 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11736 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11737
11738 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11739 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11740 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11741
11742 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11743 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011744 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11745 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011746
11747 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11748 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11749 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11750 another server.
11751
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011752 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011753 server.
11754
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011755 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11756 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11757 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11758 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11759
11760 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11761 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11762 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11763 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11764
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011765 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11766 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11767 "use-server" rule).
11768
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011769 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11770
11771 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11772 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11773
11774 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11775
11776 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11777 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11778 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11779
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011780 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11781 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11782 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11783 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11784 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11785
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011786 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11787
11788 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11789 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11790
11791 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11792
11793 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11794
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011795The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11796was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011797helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11798starvation, attacks, etc...
11799
11800The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11801alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11802easier finding and understanding.
11803
11804 Flags Reason
11805
11806 -- Normal termination.
11807
11808 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11809 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11810 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11811 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11812
11813 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11814 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11815 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11816 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11817 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11818 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011819
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11821 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011822 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011823
11824 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11825 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11826 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11827
11828 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11829 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11830 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11831 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11832 the server takes too long to respond.
11833
11834 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11835 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11836 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11837 long a time to respond.
11838
11839 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11840 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11841 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11842 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11843 and the client.
11844
11845 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11846 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11847 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11848 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11849 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11850 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11851
11852 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11853 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011854 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11855 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11856 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11857 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011858
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011859 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11860 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011862 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011863 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11864 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11865 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11866 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11867 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11868
11869 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11870 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11871 503 or 504 here.
11872
11873 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11874 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11875 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11876 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11877 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11878
11879 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11880 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011881 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011882 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11883 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11884
11885 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11886 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11887 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11888 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11889 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11890 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11891 between haproxy and the server.
11892
11893 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11894 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11895 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11896 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11897 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11898 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11899 solution is to fix the application.
11900
11901 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11902 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11903 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11904 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11905 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11906 external attacks.
11907
11908 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11909 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011910 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011911 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11912 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11913
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011914 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11915 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11916 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011917 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11918 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011920 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11921 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11922 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11923 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011924 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11925 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11926 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11927 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11928 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011929
11930 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11931 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11932 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11933 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11934
11935 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11936 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11937 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11938 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11939
11940 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11941 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11942 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11943 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11944
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011945The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11946persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11947important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11948re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11949
11950 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11951
11952 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11953 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11954 set on a GET request.
11955
11956 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11957 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011958 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011959 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11960
11961 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11962 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11963 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11964
11965 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11966 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11967 already got a cookie.
11968
11969 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11970 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11971 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11972 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11973 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11974
11975 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11976 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11977 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11978
11979 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11980 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11981 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11982
11983 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11984 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11985
11986 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11987 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11988 then advertised in the response.
11989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119918.6. Non-printable characters
11992-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011993
11994In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11995consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11996converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11997prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11998being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11999escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12000is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12001'}' when logging headers.
12002
12003Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12004issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12005containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12006
12007Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12008the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12009performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12010
12011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12013---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012014
12015Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12016achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012017section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012018cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12019the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12020the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012021locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012022not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12023user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12024a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12025wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12026
12027 Examples :
12028 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12029 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12030
12031 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12032 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12033
12034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120358.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12036---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012037
12038Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12039proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12040the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12041server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12042
12043Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12044response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012045section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012046
12047It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012048time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12049appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12051and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12052follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12053request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12054in the logs.
12055
12056 Example :
12057 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12058 listen proxy-out
12059 mode http
12060 option httplog
12061 option logasap
12062 log global
12063 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12064
12065 # log the name of the virtual server
12066 capture request header Host len 20
12067
12068 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12069 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12070
12071 # log the beginning of the referrer
12072 capture request header Referer len 20
12073
12074 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12075 capture response header Server len 20
12076
12077 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12078 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12079
12080 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12081 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12082
12083 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12084 capture response header Via len 20
12085
12086 # log the URL location during a redirection
12087 capture response header Location len 20
12088
12089 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12090 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12091 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12092 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12093 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12094
12095 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12096 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12097 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12098 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012099 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100
12101 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12102 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12103 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12104 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12105 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012106 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012107
12108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121098.9. Examples of logs
12110---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012111
12112These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12113them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12114reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12115
12116 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12117 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12118 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12119
12120 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12121 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12122
12123 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12124 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12125 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12126
12127 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12128 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12129
12130 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12131 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12132 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12133
12134 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012135 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012136 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12137 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12138
12139 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12140 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12141 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12142
12143 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12144 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012145 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012146 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12147 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12148 to return the 502 and not the server.
12149
12150 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012151 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012152
12153 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12154 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12155 Nothing was sent to any server.
12156
12157 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12158 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12159
12160 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12161 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12162 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12163 send a 408 return code to the client.
12164
12165 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12166 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12167
12168 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12169 5 seconds ("c----").
12170
12171 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12172 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012173 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012174
12175 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012176 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012177 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12178 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12179 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12180 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12181 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012182
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121849. Statistics and monitoring
12185----------------------------
12186
12187It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12188mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12189CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12190Unix socket.
12191
12192
121939.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012194---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012195
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012196The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12197page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012199 0. pxname: proxy name
12200 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12201 for server)
12202 2. qcur: current queued requests
12203 3. qmax: max queued requests
12204 4. scur: current sessions
12205 5. smax: max sessions
12206 6. slim: sessions limit
12207 7. stot: total sessions
12208 8. bin: bytes in
12209 9. bout: bytes out
12210 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012211 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012212 12. ereq: request errors
12213 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012214 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012215 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12216 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012217 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012218 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12219 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12220 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12221 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12222 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12223 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12224 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12225 25. qlimit: queue limit
12226 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12227 27. iid: unique proxy id
12228 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12229 29. throttle: warm up status
12230 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12231 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012232 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012233 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12234 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12235 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012236 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012237 UNK -> unknown
12238 INI -> initializing
12239 SOCKERR -> socket error
12240 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12241 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12242 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12243 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12244 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12245 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12246 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12247 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12248 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12249 disable-on-404
12250 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12251 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12252 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012253 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12254 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012255 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12256 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12257 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12258 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12259 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12260 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012261 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12262 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12263 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12264 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012265 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12266 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012267 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12268 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12269 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012270 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012271
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122739.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012274-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012275
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012276The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12277necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12278A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12279issuing commands by hand :
12280
12281 global
12282 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12283 stats timeout 2m
12284
12285It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12286the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12287never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12288situations :
12289
12290 global
12291 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12292 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12293 stats timeout 2m
12294
12295To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12296swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12297to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12298syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12299
12300 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12301 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12302
12303The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12304script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12305for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12306
12307The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12308that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12309editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12310(eg: watch a counter).
12311
12312The socket supports two operation modes :
12313 - interactive
12314 - non-interactive
12315
12316The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12317this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12318sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12319mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12320commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12321example :
12322
12323 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12324
12325The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12326entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12327for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12328sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12329"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12330after processing the last command of the same line.
12331
12332For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12333"prompt" command :
12334
12335 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12336 prompt
12337 > show info
12338 ...
12339 >
12340
12341Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12342delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12343that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12344parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012345
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012346It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12347on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12348own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012349
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012350The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12351If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12352all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12353it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12354
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012355add map <map> <key> <value>
12356 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12357 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12358 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12359
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012360clear counters
12361 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12362 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12363 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12364 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12365 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12366
12367clear counters all
12368 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12369 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12370 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12371
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012372clear map <map>
12373 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12374
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012375clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12376 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12377
12378 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12379 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12380 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12381 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12382 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12383 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12384
12385 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12386
12387 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12388 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12389 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12390 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12391 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12392 the ACLs :
12393
12394 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12395 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12396 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12397 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12398 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12399 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12400
12401 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012402 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12403 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012404
12405 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012406 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012407 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012408 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12409 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12410 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12411 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012412
12413 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12414
12415 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012416 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012417 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12418 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012419 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12420 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12421 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012422
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012423enable agent <backend>/<server>
12424 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12425
12426 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12427 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12428 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12429 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12430 re-enabled using enable agent.
12431
12432 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12433 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12434 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12435 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12436 otherwise unchanged.
12437
12438 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12439 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12440 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12441
12442 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12443 level "admin".
12444
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012445del map <map> <key>
12446 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12447
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012448disable frontend <frontend>
12449 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12450 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12451 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12452 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12453 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12454 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12455 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12456 on the stats page.
12457
12458 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12459 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12460
12461 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12462 level "admin".
12463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012464disable server <backend>/<server>
12465 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12466 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12467 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12468 during the maintenance.
12469
12470 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12471 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12472
12473 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012474 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012475
12476 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12477 level "admin".
12478
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012479enable agent <backend>/<server>
12480 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12481
12482 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12483 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12484
12485 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12486 level "admin".
12487
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012488enable frontend <frontend>
12489 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12490 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12491 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12492 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12493 which was disabled.
12494
12495 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12496 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12497
12498 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12499 level "admin".
12500
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012501enable server <backend>/<server>
12502 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12503 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12504
12505 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012506 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012507
12508 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12509 level "admin".
12510
12511get weight <backend>/<server>
12512 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12513 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12514 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12515 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12516 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012517 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012518
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012519help
12520 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12521 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012522
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012523prompt
12524 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12525 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12526 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12527 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12528 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12529 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12530 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12531 command.
12532
12533quit
12534 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012535
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012536set map <map> <key> <value>
12537 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12538 is <value>.
12539
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012540set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012541 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12542 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12543 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12544 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12545 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012546 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12547 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12548
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012549set maxconn global <maxconn>
12550 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12551 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12552 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12553 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12554 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12555 setting.
12556
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012557set rate-limit connections global <value>
12558 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12559 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12560 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12561 is passed in number of connections per second.
12562
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012563set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12564 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12565 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012566 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12567 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012568
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012569set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012570 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12571 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12572 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12573 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012574 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12575 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012577set timeout cli <delay>
12578 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12579 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12580 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12581
12582set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12583 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12584 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012585 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12586 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12587 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12588 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12589 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12590 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12591 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12592 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12593 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12594 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12595 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12596 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12597 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012598
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012599show errors [<iid>]
12600 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12601 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012602 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12603 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12604 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012605
12606 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12607 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12608 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12609 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12610 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12611 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12612 are reported too.
12613
12614 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12615 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12616 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12617 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12618 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12619 code.
12620
12621 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12622 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12623 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12624 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12625 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12626 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12627 line.
12628
12629 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012630 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12631 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012632 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12633 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12634
12635 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12636 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12637 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12638 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12639 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12640 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12641 00204+ minal\r\n
12642 00211 \r\n
12643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012645 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12646 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12647 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12648 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12649 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12650 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012651
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012652show info
12653 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12654
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012655show map [<map>]
12656 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12657 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12658
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012659show sess
12660 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012661 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12662 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12663
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012664show sess <id>
12665 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12666 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12667 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12668 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12669 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012670 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12671 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12672 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012673
12674show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12675 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12676 possible to dump only selected items :
12677 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12678 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12679 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12680 for example:
12681 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12682 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12683 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12684
12685 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012686 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12687 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012688 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12689 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12690 Nbproc: 1
12691 Process_num: 1
12692 (...)
12693
12694 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12695 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12696 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12697 (...)
12698 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12699
12700 $
12701
12702 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12703 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12704 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12705 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012706 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012707
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012708show table
12709 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12710 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12711 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12712 entries currently in use.
12713
12714 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012715 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012716 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12717 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012718
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012719show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012720 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12721 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12722 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012723 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12724
12725 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12726 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12727 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12728 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12729 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12730
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012731 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12732 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12733 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12734 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12735 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12736 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12737
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012738
12739 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012740 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12741 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012742
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012743 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012744 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012745 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012746 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12747 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12748 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12749 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012750
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012751 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012752 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012753 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12754 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012755
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012756 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12757 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012758 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012759 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12760 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012761
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012762 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12763 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012764 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012765 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12766 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12767
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012768 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12769 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12770 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12771 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12772 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12773
12774 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12775 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12776 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012777 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12778 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012779 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12780 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012781
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012782shutdown frontend <frontend>
12783 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12784 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12785 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12786 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12787 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12788 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12789 once it is terminated.
12790
12791 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12792 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12793
12794 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12795 level "admin".
12796
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012797shutdown session <id>
12798 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12799 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12800 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12801 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12802 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12803 flag in the logs.
12804
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012805shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12806 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12807 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12808 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12809 'K' flag in the logs.
12810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012811/*
12812 * Local variables:
12813 * fill-column: 79
12814 * End:
12815 */